1 //===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===// 2 // 3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions. 4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information. 5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception 6 // 7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8 // 9 // This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading. 10 // 11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 12 13 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 14 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 15 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/DependenceFlags.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h" 21 #include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h" 22 #include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticOptions.h" 23 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 24 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h" 25 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 26 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 27 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 28 #include "clang/Sema/Overload.h" 29 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 30 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 31 #include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h" 32 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h" 33 #include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h" 34 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h" 35 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h" 36 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h" 37 #include <algorithm> 38 #include <cstdlib> 39 40 using namespace clang; 41 using namespace sema; 42 43 using AllowedExplicit = Sema::AllowedExplicit; 44 45 static bool functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 46 return llvm::any_of(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) { 47 return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 48 }); 49 } 50 51 /// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function. 52 static ExprResult 53 CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 54 const Expr *Base, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 55 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(), 56 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){ 57 if (S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc)) 58 return ExprError(); 59 // If FoundDecl is different from Fn (such as if one is a template 60 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is 61 // called on both. 62 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying 63 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl 64 // being used. 65 if (FoundDecl != Fn && S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Fn, Loc)) 66 return ExprError(); 67 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) 68 DeclRefExpr(S.Context, Fn, false, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo); 69 if (HadMultipleCandidates) 70 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true); 71 72 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE, Base); 73 if (auto *FPT = DRE->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 74 if (isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType())) { 75 S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT); 76 DRE->setType(Fn->getType()); 77 } 78 } 79 return S.ImpCastExprToType(DRE, S.Context.getPointerType(DRE->getType()), 80 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay); 81 } 82 83 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 84 bool InOverloadResolution, 85 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 86 bool CStyle, 87 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 88 89 static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, 90 QualType &ToType, 91 bool InOverloadResolution, 92 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 93 bool CStyle); 94 static OverloadingResult 95 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 96 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User, 97 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions, 98 AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, 99 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 100 101 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 102 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 103 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 104 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 105 106 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 107 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 108 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 109 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 110 111 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 112 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 113 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 114 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 115 116 /// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank 117 /// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind. 118 ImplicitConversionRank clang::GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 119 static const ImplicitConversionRank 120 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 121 ICR_Exact_Match, 122 ICR_Exact_Match, 123 ICR_Exact_Match, 124 ICR_Exact_Match, 125 ICR_Exact_Match, 126 ICR_Exact_Match, 127 ICR_Promotion, 128 ICR_Promotion, 129 ICR_Promotion, 130 ICR_Conversion, 131 ICR_Conversion, 132 ICR_Conversion, 133 ICR_Conversion, 134 ICR_Conversion, 135 ICR_Conversion, 136 ICR_Conversion, 137 ICR_Conversion, 138 ICR_Conversion, 139 ICR_Conversion, 140 ICR_Conversion, 141 ICR_OCL_Scalar_Widening, 142 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion, 143 ICR_Conversion, 144 ICR_Conversion, 145 ICR_Writeback_Conversion, 146 ICR_Exact_Match, // NOTE(gbiv): This may not be completely right -- 147 // it was omitted by the patch that added 148 // ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion 149 ICR_C_Conversion, 150 ICR_C_Conversion_Extension 151 }; 152 return Rank[(int)Kind]; 153 } 154 155 /// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of 156 /// implicit conversion. 157 static const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 158 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 159 "No conversion", 160 "Lvalue-to-rvalue", 161 "Array-to-pointer", 162 "Function-to-pointer", 163 "Function pointer conversion", 164 "Qualification", 165 "Integral promotion", 166 "Floating point promotion", 167 "Complex promotion", 168 "Integral conversion", 169 "Floating conversion", 170 "Complex conversion", 171 "Floating-integral conversion", 172 "Pointer conversion", 173 "Pointer-to-member conversion", 174 "Boolean conversion", 175 "Compatible-types conversion", 176 "Derived-to-base conversion", 177 "Vector conversion", 178 "SVE Vector conversion", 179 "Vector splat", 180 "Complex-real conversion", 181 "Block Pointer conversion", 182 "Transparent Union Conversion", 183 "Writeback conversion", 184 "OpenCL Zero Event Conversion", 185 "C specific type conversion", 186 "Incompatible pointer conversion" 187 }; 188 return Name[Kind]; 189 } 190 191 /// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion 192 /// sequence to the identity conversion. 193 void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() { 194 First = ICK_Identity; 195 Second = ICK_Identity; 196 Third = ICK_Identity; 197 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 198 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false; 199 ReferenceBinding = false; 200 DirectBinding = false; 201 IsLvalueReference = true; 202 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 203 BindsToRvalue = false; 204 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 205 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 206 CopyConstructor = nullptr; 207 } 208 209 /// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence 210 /// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the 211 /// implicit conversions. 212 ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const { 213 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match; 214 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank) 215 Rank = GetConversionRank(First); 216 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank) 217 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second); 218 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank) 219 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third); 220 return Rank; 221 } 222 223 /// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is 224 /// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is 225 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences 226 /// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4). 227 bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const { 228 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 229 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so 230 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is 231 // a pointer. 232 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() && 233 (getFromType()->isPointerType() || 234 getFromType()->isMemberPointerType() || 235 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 236 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() || 237 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer)) 238 return true; 239 240 return false; 241 } 242 243 /// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this 244 /// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is 245 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++ 246 /// 13.3.3.2p4). 247 bool 248 StandardConversionSequence:: 249 isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const { 250 QualType FromType = getFromType(); 251 QualType ToType = getToType(1); 252 253 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 254 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence 255 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer. 256 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 257 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 258 259 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType()) 260 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 261 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType(); 262 263 return false; 264 } 265 266 /// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion 267 /// or after one in an implicit conversion. 268 static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(ASTContext &Ctx, 269 const Expr *Converted) { 270 // We can have cleanups wrapping the converted expression; these need to be 271 // preserved so that destructors run if necessary. 272 if (auto *EWC = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Converted)) { 273 Expr *Inner = 274 const_cast<Expr *>(IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, EWC->getSubExpr())); 275 return ExprWithCleanups::Create(Ctx, Inner, EWC->cleanupsHaveSideEffects(), 276 EWC->getObjects()); 277 } 278 279 while (auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) { 280 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) { 281 case CK_NoOp: 282 case CK_IntegralCast: 283 case CK_IntegralToBoolean: 284 case CK_IntegralToFloating: 285 case CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral: 286 case CK_FloatingToIntegral: 287 case CK_FloatingToBoolean: 288 case CK_FloatingCast: 289 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr(); 290 continue; 291 292 default: 293 return Converted; 294 } 295 } 296 297 return Converted; 298 } 299 300 /// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing 301 /// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7. 302 /// 303 /// \param Ctx The AST context. 304 /// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence. 305 /// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the 306 /// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion. 307 /// \param ConstantType If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the 308 /// type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion. 309 /// \param IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion If true type-narrowing conversions 310 /// from floating point types to integral types should be ignored. 311 NarrowingKind StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind( 312 ASTContext &Ctx, const Expr *Converted, APValue &ConstantValue, 313 QualType &ConstantType, bool IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion) const { 314 assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++"); 315 316 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7: 317 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ... 318 QualType FromType = getToType(0); 319 QualType ToType = getToType(1); 320 321 // A conversion to an enumeration type is narrowing if the conversion to 322 // the underlying type is narrowing. This only arises for expressions of 323 // the form 'Enum{init}'. 324 if (auto *ET = ToType->getAs<EnumType>()) 325 ToType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 326 327 switch (Second) { 328 // 'bool' is an integral type; dispatch to the right place to handle it. 329 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: 330 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType()) 331 goto FloatingIntegralConversion; 332 if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) 333 goto IntegralConversion; 334 // -- from a pointer type or pointer-to-member type to bool, or 335 return NK_Type_Narrowing; 336 337 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or 338 // 339 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point 340 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual 341 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce 342 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or 343 case ICK_Floating_Integral: 344 FloatingIntegralConversion: 345 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) { 346 return NK_Type_Narrowing; 347 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 348 ToType->isRealFloatingType()) { 349 if (IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion) 350 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 351 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted); 352 assert(Initializer && "Unknown conversion expression"); 353 354 // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing. 355 if (Initializer->isValueDependent()) 356 return NK_Dependent_Narrowing; 357 358 if (Optional<llvm::APSInt> IntConstantValue = 359 Initializer->getIntegerConstantExpr(Ctx)) { 360 // Convert the integer to the floating type. 361 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)); 362 Result.convertFromAPInt(*IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue->isSigned(), 363 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven); 364 // And back. 365 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = *IntConstantValue; 366 bool ignored; 367 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue, 368 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored); 369 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion. 370 if (*IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) { 371 ConstantValue = APValue(*IntConstantValue); 372 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 373 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 374 } 375 } else { 376 // Variables are always narrowings. 377 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 378 } 379 } 380 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 381 382 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except 383 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after 384 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even 385 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or 386 case ICK_Floating_Conversion: 387 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() && 388 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) { 389 // FromType is larger than ToType. 390 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted); 391 392 // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing. 393 if (Initializer->isValueDependent()) 394 return NK_Dependent_Narrowing; 395 396 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) { 397 // Constant! 398 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat()); 399 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat(); 400 // Convert the source value into the target type. 401 bool ignored; 402 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert( 403 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType), 404 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored); 405 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of 406 // values that can be represented. 407 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) { 408 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 409 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 410 } 411 } else { 412 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 413 } 414 } 415 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 416 417 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type 418 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where 419 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after 420 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original 421 // value when converted back to the original type. 422 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: 423 IntegralConversion: { 424 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()); 425 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()); 426 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 427 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType); 428 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 429 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType); 430 431 if (FromWidth > ToWidth || 432 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) || 433 (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) { 434 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType. 435 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted); 436 437 // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing. 438 if (Initializer->isValueDependent()) 439 return NK_Dependent_Narrowing; 440 441 Optional<llvm::APSInt> OptInitializerValue; 442 if (!(OptInitializerValue = Initializer->getIntegerConstantExpr(Ctx))) { 443 // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing. 444 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 445 } 446 llvm::APSInt &InitializerValue = *OptInitializerValue; 447 bool Narrowing = false; 448 if (FromWidth < ToWidth) { 449 // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never 450 // narrowing. 451 if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative()) 452 Narrowing = true; 453 } else { 454 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about 455 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons. 456 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend( 457 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1); 458 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness. 459 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue; 460 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth); 461 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned); 462 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth()); 463 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned()); 464 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion. 465 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue) 466 Narrowing = true; 467 } 468 if (Narrowing) { 469 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 470 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue); 471 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 472 } 473 } 474 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 475 } 476 477 default: 478 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings. 479 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 480 } 481 } 482 483 /// dump - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard 484 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 485 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void StandardConversionSequence::dump() const { 486 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 487 bool PrintedSomething = false; 488 if (First != ICK_Identity) { 489 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First); 490 PrintedSomething = true; 491 } 492 493 if (Second != ICK_Identity) { 494 if (PrintedSomething) { 495 OS << " -> "; 496 } 497 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second); 498 499 if (CopyConstructor) { 500 OS << " (by copy constructor)"; 501 } else if (DirectBinding) { 502 OS << " (direct reference binding)"; 503 } else if (ReferenceBinding) { 504 OS << " (reference binding)"; 505 } 506 PrintedSomething = true; 507 } 508 509 if (Third != ICK_Identity) { 510 if (PrintedSomething) { 511 OS << " -> "; 512 } 513 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third); 514 PrintedSomething = true; 515 } 516 517 if (!PrintedSomething) { 518 OS << "No conversions required"; 519 } 520 } 521 522 /// dump - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard 523 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 524 void UserDefinedConversionSequence::dump() const { 525 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 526 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) { 527 Before.dump(); 528 OS << " -> "; 529 } 530 if (ConversionFunction) 531 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\''; 532 else 533 OS << "aggregate initialization"; 534 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) { 535 OS << " -> "; 536 After.dump(); 537 } 538 } 539 540 /// dump - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard 541 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 542 void ImplicitConversionSequence::dump() const { 543 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 544 if (isStdInitializerListElement()) 545 OS << "Worst std::initializer_list element conversion: "; 546 switch (ConversionKind) { 547 case StandardConversion: 548 OS << "Standard conversion: "; 549 Standard.dump(); 550 break; 551 case UserDefinedConversion: 552 OS << "User-defined conversion: "; 553 UserDefined.dump(); 554 break; 555 case EllipsisConversion: 556 OS << "Ellipsis conversion"; 557 break; 558 case AmbiguousConversion: 559 OS << "Ambiguous conversion"; 560 break; 561 case BadConversion: 562 OS << "Bad conversion"; 563 break; 564 } 565 566 OS << "\n"; 567 } 568 569 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() { 570 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(); 571 } 572 573 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() { 574 conversions().~ConversionSet(); 575 } 576 577 void 578 AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) { 579 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr; 580 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr; 581 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions()); 582 } 583 584 namespace { 585 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store 586 // template argument information. 587 struct DFIArguments { 588 TemplateArgument FirstArg; 589 TemplateArgument SecondArg; 590 }; 591 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store 592 // template parameter and template argument information. 593 struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments { 594 TemplateParameter Param; 595 }; 596 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store template argument 597 // information and the index of the problematic call argument. 598 struct DFIDeducedMismatchArgs : DFIArguments { 599 TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs; 600 unsigned CallArgIndex; 601 }; 602 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store information about 603 // unsatisfied constraints. 604 struct CNSInfo { 605 TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs; 606 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 607 }; 608 } 609 610 /// Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information 611 /// to the form used in overload-candidate information. 612 DeductionFailureInfo 613 clang::MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context, 614 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK, 615 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) { 616 DeductionFailureInfo Result; 617 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK); 618 Result.HasDiagnostic = false; 619 switch (TDK) { 620 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 621 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 622 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 623 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 624 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 625 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 626 Result.Data = nullptr; 627 break; 628 629 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 630 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 631 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue(); 632 break; 633 634 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 635 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: { 636 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 637 auto *Saved = new (Context) DFIDeducedMismatchArgs; 638 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 639 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 640 Saved->TemplateArgs = Info.take(); 641 Saved->CallArgIndex = Info.CallArgIndex; 642 Result.Data = Saved; 643 break; 644 } 645 646 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: { 647 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 648 DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments; 649 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 650 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 651 Result.Data = Saved; 652 break; 653 } 654 655 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 656 // FIXME: It's slightly wasteful to allocate two TemplateArguments for this. 657 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 658 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 659 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 660 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments; 661 Saved->Param = Info.Param; 662 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 663 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 664 Result.Data = Saved; 665 break; 666 } 667 668 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 669 Result.Data = Info.take(); 670 if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 671 PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt( 672 SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic()); 673 Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag); 674 Result.HasDiagnostic = true; 675 } 676 break; 677 678 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: { 679 CNSInfo *Saved = new (Context) CNSInfo; 680 Saved->TemplateArgs = Info.take(); 681 Saved->Satisfaction = Info.AssociatedConstraintsSatisfaction; 682 Result.Data = Saved; 683 break; 684 } 685 686 case Sema::TDK_Success: 687 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 688 llvm_unreachable("not a deduction failure"); 689 } 690 691 return Result; 692 } 693 694 void DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() { 695 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 696 case Sema::TDK_Success: 697 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 698 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 699 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 700 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 701 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 702 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 703 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 704 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 705 break; 706 707 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 708 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 709 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 710 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 711 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 712 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 713 // FIXME: Destroy the data? 714 Data = nullptr; 715 break; 716 717 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 718 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list? 719 Data = nullptr; 720 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 721 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt(); 722 HasDiagnostic = false; 723 } 724 break; 725 726 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 727 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list? 728 Data = nullptr; 729 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 730 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt(); 731 HasDiagnostic = false; 732 } 733 break; 734 735 // Unhandled 736 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 737 break; 738 } 739 } 740 741 PartialDiagnosticAt *DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() { 742 if (HasDiagnostic) 743 return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic)); 744 return nullptr; 745 } 746 747 TemplateParameter DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() { 748 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 749 case Sema::TDK_Success: 750 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 751 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 752 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 753 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 754 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 755 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 756 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 757 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 758 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 759 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 760 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 761 return TemplateParameter(); 762 763 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 764 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 765 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data); 766 767 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 768 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 769 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 770 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param; 771 772 // Unhandled 773 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 774 break; 775 } 776 777 return TemplateParameter(); 778 } 779 780 TemplateArgumentList *DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() { 781 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 782 case Sema::TDK_Success: 783 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 784 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 785 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 786 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 787 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 788 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 789 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 790 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 791 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 792 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 793 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 794 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 795 return nullptr; 796 797 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 798 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 799 return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->TemplateArgs; 800 801 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 802 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data); 803 804 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 805 return static_cast<CNSInfo*>(Data)->TemplateArgs; 806 807 // Unhandled 808 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 809 break; 810 } 811 812 return nullptr; 813 } 814 815 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() { 816 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 817 case Sema::TDK_Success: 818 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 819 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 820 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 821 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 822 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 823 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 824 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 825 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 826 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 827 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 828 return nullptr; 829 830 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 831 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 832 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 833 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 834 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 835 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 836 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg; 837 838 // Unhandled 839 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 840 break; 841 } 842 843 return nullptr; 844 } 845 846 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() { 847 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 848 case Sema::TDK_Success: 849 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 850 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 851 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 852 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 853 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 854 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 855 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 856 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 857 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 858 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 859 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 860 return nullptr; 861 862 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 863 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 864 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 865 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 866 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 867 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg; 868 869 // Unhandled 870 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 871 break; 872 } 873 874 return nullptr; 875 } 876 877 llvm::Optional<unsigned> DeductionFailureInfo::getCallArgIndex() { 878 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 879 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 880 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 881 return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->CallArgIndex; 882 883 default: 884 return llvm::None; 885 } 886 } 887 888 bool OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo::shouldAddReversed( 889 OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 890 if (!AllowRewrittenCandidates) 891 return false; 892 return Op == OO_EqualEqual || Op == OO_Spaceship; 893 } 894 895 bool OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo::shouldAddReversed( 896 ASTContext &Ctx, const FunctionDecl *FD) { 897 if (!shouldAddReversed(FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator())) 898 return false; 899 // Don't bother adding a reversed candidate that can never be a better 900 // match than the non-reversed version. 901 return FD->getNumParams() != 2 || 902 !Ctx.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FD->getParamDecl(0)->getType(), 903 FD->getParamDecl(1)->getType()) || 904 FD->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>(); 905 } 906 907 void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() { 908 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) { 909 for (auto &C : i->Conversions) 910 C.~ImplicitConversionSequence(); 911 if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 912 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy(); 913 } 914 } 915 916 void OverloadCandidateSet::clear(CandidateSetKind CSK) { 917 destroyCandidates(); 918 SlabAllocator.Reset(); 919 NumInlineBytesUsed = 0; 920 Candidates.clear(); 921 Functions.clear(); 922 Kind = CSK; 923 } 924 925 namespace { 926 class UnbridgedCastsSet { 927 struct Entry { 928 Expr **Addr; 929 Expr *Saved; 930 }; 931 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries; 932 933 public: 934 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) { 935 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast)); 936 Entry entry = { &E, E }; 937 Entries.push_back(entry); 938 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 939 } 940 941 void restore() { 942 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator 943 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i) 944 *i->Addr = i->Saved; 945 } 946 }; 947 } 948 949 /// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like 950 /// preprocessing on the given expression. 951 /// 952 /// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts; 953 /// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors 954 /// 955 /// Return true on unrecoverable error. 956 static bool 957 checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E, 958 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = nullptr) { 959 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 960 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload 961 // resolution might reasonably tweak them. 962 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false; 963 964 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip 965 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration. 966 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast && 967 unbridgedCasts) { 968 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E); 969 return false; 970 } 971 972 // Go ahead and check everything else. 973 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 974 if (result.isInvalid()) 975 return true; 976 977 E = result.get(); 978 return false; 979 } 980 981 // Nothing to do. 982 return false; 983 } 984 985 /// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for 986 /// placeholders. 987 static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S, 988 MultiExprArg Args, 989 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) { 990 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) 991 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, Args[i], &unbridged)) 992 return true; 993 994 return false; 995 } 996 997 /// Determine whether the given New declaration is an overload of the 998 /// declarations in Old. This routine returns Ovl_Match or Ovl_NonFunction if 999 /// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same signature as 1000 /// some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old declarations aren't 1001 /// functions (or function templates) at all. When it does return Ovl_Match or 1002 /// Ovl_NonFunction, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New cannot be 1003 /// overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on top of the underlying 1004 /// declaration. 1005 /// 1006 /// Example: Given the following input: 1007 /// 1008 /// void f(int, float); // #1 1009 /// void f(int, int); // #2 1010 /// int f(int, int); // #3 1011 /// 1012 /// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f", so IsOverload 1013 /// will not be used. 1014 /// 1015 /// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By comparing 1016 /// the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded (since they have 1017 /// different signatures), so this routine returns Ovl_Overload; MatchedDecl is 1018 /// unchanged. 1019 /// 1020 /// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We compare 1021 /// the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do nothing) and then 1022 /// #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are identical (return types of 1023 /// functions are not part of the signature), IsOverload returns Ovl_Match and 1024 /// MatchedDecl will be set to point to the FunctionDecl for #2. 1025 /// 1026 /// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced into a class 1027 /// by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide shadow declarations 1028 /// ignore some properties which otherwise figure into a function template's 1029 /// signature. 1030 Sema::OverloadKind 1031 Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old, 1032 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) { 1033 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end(); 1034 I != E; ++I) { 1035 NamedDecl *OldD = *I; 1036 1037 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false; 1038 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) { 1039 OldIsUsingDecl = true; 1040 1041 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same 1042 // context, even if they have identical signatures. 1043 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue; 1044 1045 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl(); 1046 } 1047 1048 // A using-declaration does not conflict with another declaration 1049 // if one of them is hidden. 1050 if ((OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && !isVisible(*I)) 1051 continue; 1052 1053 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration, 1054 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching. 1055 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that 1056 // function templates hide function templates with different 1057 // return types or template parameter lists. 1058 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules = 1059 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord() && 1060 !New->getFriendObjectKind(); 1061 1062 if (FunctionDecl *OldF = OldD->getAsFunction()) { 1063 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) { 1064 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) { 1065 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I)); 1066 continue; 1067 } 1068 1069 if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD) && 1070 !shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(*I, New)) 1071 continue; 1072 1073 Match = *I; 1074 return Ovl_Match; 1075 } 1076 1077 // Builtins that have custom typechecking or have a reference should 1078 // not be overloadable or redeclarable. 1079 if (!getASTContext().canBuiltinBeRedeclared(OldF)) { 1080 Match = *I; 1081 return Ovl_NonFunction; 1082 } 1083 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD) || isa<UsingPackDecl>(OldD)) { 1084 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing 1085 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls. 1086 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName); 1087 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) { 1088 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them. 1089 } else if (auto *UUD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) { 1090 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will 1091 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during 1092 // template instantiation. 1093 // 1094 // Exception: if the scope is dependent and this is not a class 1095 // member, the using declaration can only introduce an enumerator. 1096 if (UUD->getQualifier()->isDependent() && !UUD->isCXXClassMember()) { 1097 Match = *I; 1098 return Ovl_NonFunction; 1099 } 1100 } else { 1101 // (C++ 13p1): 1102 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type 1103 // declarations cannot be overloaded. 1104 Match = *I; 1105 return Ovl_NonFunction; 1106 } 1107 } 1108 1109 // C++ [temp.friend]p1: 1110 // For a friend function declaration that is not a template declaration: 1111 // -- if the name of the friend is a qualified or unqualified template-id, 1112 // [...], otherwise 1113 // -- if the name of the friend is a qualified-id and a matching 1114 // non-template function is found in the specified class or namespace, 1115 // the friend declaration refers to that function, otherwise, 1116 // -- if the name of the friend is a qualified-id and a matching function 1117 // template is found in the specified class or namespace, the friend 1118 // declaration refers to the deduced specialization of that function 1119 // template, otherwise 1120 // -- the name shall be an unqualified-id [...] 1121 // If we get here for a qualified friend declaration, we've just reached the 1122 // third bullet. If the type of the friend is dependent, skip this lookup 1123 // until instantiation. 1124 if (New->getFriendObjectKind() && New->getQualifier() && 1125 !New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 1126 !New->getDependentSpecializationInfo() && 1127 !New->getType()->isDependentType()) { 1128 LookupResult TemplateSpecResult(LookupResult::Temporary, Old); 1129 TemplateSpecResult.addAllDecls(Old); 1130 if (CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization(New, nullptr, TemplateSpecResult, 1131 /*QualifiedFriend*/true)) { 1132 New->setInvalidDecl(); 1133 return Ovl_Overload; 1134 } 1135 1136 Match = TemplateSpecResult.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>(); 1137 return Ovl_Match; 1138 } 1139 1140 return Ovl_Overload; 1141 } 1142 1143 bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old, 1144 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules, bool ConsiderCudaAttrs, 1145 bool ConsiderRequiresClauses) { 1146 // C++ [basic.start.main]p2: This function shall not be overloaded. 1147 if (New->isMain()) 1148 return false; 1149 1150 // MSVCRT user defined entry points cannot be overloaded. 1151 if (New->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 1152 return false; 1153 1154 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 1155 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 1156 1157 // C++ [temp.fct]p2: 1158 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates 1159 // and with normal (non-template) functions. 1160 if ((OldTemplate == nullptr) != (NewTemplate == nullptr)) 1161 return true; 1162 1163 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old? 1164 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 1165 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 1166 1167 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to 1168 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch 1169 // in the signature, they are overloads. 1170 1171 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no 1172 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures. 1173 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) || 1174 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr())) 1175 return false; 1176 1177 const FunctionProtoType *OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType); 1178 const FunctionProtoType *NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType); 1179 1180 // The signature of a function includes the types of its 1181 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence 1182 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357). 1183 if (OldQType != NewQType && 1184 (OldType->getNumParams() != NewType->getNumParams() || 1185 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() || 1186 !FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType))) 1187 return true; 1188 1189 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4: 1190 // The signature of a function template consists of its function 1191 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names 1192 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the 1193 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the 1194 // signature. 1195 // 1196 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function 1197 // templates first; the remaining checks follow. 1198 // 1199 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether 1200 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden. 1201 if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate && 1202 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 1203 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 1204 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) || 1205 !Context.hasSameType(Old->getDeclaredReturnType(), 1206 New->getDeclaredReturnType()))) 1207 return true; 1208 1209 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the 1210 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself. 1211 // 1212 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions 1213 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++ 1214 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature, 1215 // this check is important to determine whether these functions 1216 // can be overloaded. 1217 CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old); 1218 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New); 1219 if (OldMethod && NewMethod && 1220 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) { 1221 if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) { 1222 if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules && 1223 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None || 1224 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) { 1225 // C++0x [over.load]p2: 1226 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same 1227 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template 1228 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and 1229 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of 1230 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5). 1231 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload) 1232 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier(); 1233 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 1234 } 1235 return true; 1236 } 1237 1238 // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member 1239 // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static 1240 // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this 1241 // is a redeclaration of OldMethod. 1242 auto OldQuals = OldMethod->getMethodQualifiers(); 1243 auto NewQuals = NewMethod->getMethodQualifiers(); 1244 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && NewMethod->isConstexpr() && 1245 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod)) 1246 NewQuals.addConst(); 1247 // We do not allow overloading based off of '__restrict'. 1248 OldQuals.removeRestrict(); 1249 NewQuals.removeRestrict(); 1250 if (OldQuals != NewQuals) 1251 return true; 1252 } 1253 1254 // Though pass_object_size is placed on parameters and takes an argument, we 1255 // consider it to be a function-level modifier for the sake of function 1256 // identity. Either the function has one or more parameters with 1257 // pass_object_size or it doesn't. 1258 if (functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(New) != 1259 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Old)) 1260 return true; 1261 1262 // enable_if attributes are an order-sensitive part of the signature. 1263 for (specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr> 1264 NewI = New->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(), 1265 NewE = New->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(), 1266 OldI = Old->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(), 1267 OldE = Old->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(); 1268 NewI != NewE || OldI != OldE; ++NewI, ++OldI) { 1269 if (NewI == NewE || OldI == OldE) 1270 return true; 1271 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID; 1272 NewI->getCond()->Profile(NewID, Context, true); 1273 OldI->getCond()->Profile(OldID, Context, true); 1274 if (NewID != OldID) 1275 return true; 1276 } 1277 1278 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && ConsiderCudaAttrs) { 1279 // Don't allow overloading of destructors. (In theory we could, but it 1280 // would be a giant change to clang.) 1281 if (!isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(New)) { 1282 CUDAFunctionTarget NewTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(New), 1283 OldTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(Old); 1284 if (NewTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) { 1285 assert((OldTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) && 1286 "Unexpected invalid target."); 1287 1288 // Allow overloading of functions with same signature and different CUDA 1289 // target attributes. 1290 if (NewTarget != OldTarget) 1291 return true; 1292 } 1293 } 1294 } 1295 1296 if (ConsiderRequiresClauses) { 1297 Expr *NewRC = New->getTrailingRequiresClause(), 1298 *OldRC = Old->getTrailingRequiresClause(); 1299 if ((NewRC != nullptr) != (OldRC != nullptr)) 1300 // RC are most certainly different - these are overloads. 1301 return true; 1302 1303 if (NewRC) { 1304 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID; 1305 NewRC->Profile(NewID, Context, /*Canonical=*/true); 1306 OldRC->Profile(OldID, Context, /*Canonical=*/true); 1307 if (NewID != OldID) 1308 // RCs are not equivalent - these are overloads. 1309 return true; 1310 } 1311 } 1312 1313 // The signatures match; this is not an overload. 1314 return false; 1315 } 1316 1317 /// Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType. 1318 /// 1319 /// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion 1320 /// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information. 1321 static ImplicitConversionSequence 1322 TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1323 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1324 AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, 1325 bool InOverloadResolution, 1326 bool CStyle, 1327 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1328 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 1329 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1330 1331 if (SuppressUserConversions) { 1332 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that 1333 // we can perform. 1334 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1335 return ICS; 1336 } 1337 1338 // Attempt user-defined conversion. 1339 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc(), 1340 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 1341 switch (IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, 1342 Conversions, AllowExplicit, 1343 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) { 1344 case OR_Success: 1345 case OR_Deleted: 1346 ICS.setUserDefined(); 1347 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 1348 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 1349 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 1350 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 1351 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy 1352 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 1353 // called for those cases. 1354 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 1355 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) { 1356 QualType FromCanon 1357 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 1358 QualType ToCanon 1359 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 1360 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() && 1361 (FromCanon == ToCanon || 1362 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromCanon, ToCanon))) { 1363 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it 1364 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences. 1365 DeclAccessPair Found = ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction; 1366 ICS.setStandard(); 1367 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1368 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType()); 1369 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 1370 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor; 1371 ICS.Standard.FoundCopyConstructor = Found; 1372 if (ToCanon != FromCanon) 1373 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 1374 } 1375 } 1376 break; 1377 1378 case OR_Ambiguous: 1379 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 1380 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType()); 1381 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType); 1382 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin(); 1383 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand) 1384 if (Cand->Best) 1385 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function); 1386 break; 1387 1388 // Fall through. 1389 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 1390 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1391 break; 1392 } 1393 1394 return ICS; 1395 } 1396 1397 /// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion 1398 /// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This 1399 /// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used 1400 /// to perform the initialization. Given 1401 /// 1402 /// void f(float f); 1403 /// void g(int i) { f(i); } 1404 /// 1405 /// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to 1406 /// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard 1407 /// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++ 1408 /// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9). 1409 // 1410 /// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be 1411 /// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such, 1412 /// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available, 1413 /// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind 1414 /// "BadConversion". 1415 /// 1416 /// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are 1417 /// not permitted. 1418 /// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are 1419 /// permitted. 1420 /// 1421 /// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C 1422 /// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to 1423 /// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments. 1424 static ImplicitConversionSequence 1425 TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1426 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1427 AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, 1428 bool InOverloadResolution, 1429 bool CStyle, 1430 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1431 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 1432 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1433 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 1434 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){ 1435 ICS.setStandard(); 1436 return ICS; 1437 } 1438 1439 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 1440 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1441 return ICS; 1442 } 1443 1444 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 1445 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 1446 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 1447 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 1448 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move 1449 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 1450 // called for those cases. 1451 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 1452 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() && 1453 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) || 1454 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromType, ToType))) { 1455 ICS.setStandard(); 1456 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1457 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 1458 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 1459 1460 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid 1461 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it 1462 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the 1463 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed. 1464 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 1465 1466 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion. 1467 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1468 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 1469 1470 return ICS; 1471 } 1472 1473 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 1474 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle, 1475 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1476 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 1477 } 1478 1479 ImplicitConversionSequence 1480 Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1481 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1482 AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, 1483 bool InOverloadResolution, 1484 bool CStyle, 1485 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 1486 return ::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 1487 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle, 1488 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1489 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 1490 } 1491 1492 /// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the 1493 /// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the 1494 /// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're 1495 /// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit, 1496 /// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted. 1497 ExprResult Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1498 AssignmentAction Action, 1499 bool AllowExplicit) { 1500 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 1501 return ExprError(); 1502 1503 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion. 1504 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion 1505 = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 1506 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending); 1507 if (getLangOpts().ObjC) 1508 CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType, 1509 From->getType(), From); 1510 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = ::TryImplicitConversion( 1511 *this, From, ToType, 1512 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 1513 AllowExplicit ? AllowedExplicit::All : AllowedExplicit::None, 1514 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 1515 /*CStyle=*/false, AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1516 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 1517 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action); 1518 } 1519 1520 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 1521 /// conversion that strips "noexcept" or "noreturn" off the nested function 1522 /// type. 1523 bool Sema::IsFunctionConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 1524 QualType &ResultTy) { 1525 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1526 return false; 1527 1528 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t) 1529 // or F(t noexcept) -> F(t) 1530 // where F adds one of the following at most once: 1531 // - a pointer 1532 // - a member pointer 1533 // - a block pointer 1534 // Changes here need matching changes in FindCompositePointerType. 1535 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1536 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1537 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass(); 1538 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false; 1539 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) { 1540 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) { 1541 CanTo = CanTo.castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1542 CanFrom = CanFrom.castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1543 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) { 1544 CanTo = CanTo.castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1545 CanFrom = CanFrom.castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1546 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) { 1547 auto ToMPT = CanTo.castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 1548 auto FromMPT = CanFrom.castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 1549 // A function pointer conversion cannot change the class of the function. 1550 if (ToMPT->getClass() != FromMPT->getClass()) 1551 return false; 1552 CanTo = ToMPT->getPointeeType(); 1553 CanFrom = FromMPT->getPointeeType(); 1554 } else { 1555 return false; 1556 } 1557 1558 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass(); 1559 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false; 1560 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) 1561 return false; 1562 } 1563 1564 const auto *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom); 1565 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo(); 1566 1567 const auto *ToFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanTo); 1568 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFn->getExtInfo(); 1569 1570 bool Changed = false; 1571 1572 // Drop 'noreturn' if not present in target type. 1573 if (FromEInfo.getNoReturn() && !ToEInfo.getNoReturn()) { 1574 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, FromEInfo.withNoReturn(false)); 1575 Changed = true; 1576 } 1577 1578 // Drop 'noexcept' if not present in target type. 1579 if (const auto *FromFPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFn)) { 1580 const auto *ToFPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFn); 1581 if (FromFPT->isNothrow() && !ToFPT->isNothrow()) { 1582 FromFn = cast<FunctionType>( 1583 Context.getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(QualType(FromFPT, 0), 1584 EST_None) 1585 .getTypePtr()); 1586 Changed = true; 1587 } 1588 1589 // Convert FromFPT's ExtParameterInfo if necessary. The conversion is valid 1590 // only if the ExtParameterInfo lists of the two function prototypes can be 1591 // merged and the merged list is identical to ToFPT's ExtParameterInfo list. 1592 SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos; 1593 bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT; 1594 if (Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFPT, FromFPT, CanUseToFPT, 1595 CanUseFromFPT, NewParamInfos) && 1596 CanUseToFPT && !CanUseFromFPT) { 1597 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ExtInfo = FromFPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 1598 ExtInfo.ExtParameterInfos = 1599 NewParamInfos.empty() ? nullptr : NewParamInfos.data(); 1600 QualType QT = Context.getFunctionType(FromFPT->getReturnType(), 1601 FromFPT->getParamTypes(), ExtInfo); 1602 FromFn = QT->getAs<FunctionType>(); 1603 Changed = true; 1604 } 1605 } 1606 1607 if (!Changed) 1608 return false; 1609 1610 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical()); 1611 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false; 1612 1613 ResultTy = ToType; 1614 return true; 1615 } 1616 1617 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 1618 /// vector conversion. 1619 /// 1620 /// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector 1621 /// conversion. 1622 static bool IsVectorConversion(Sema &S, QualType FromType, 1623 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) { 1624 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector 1625 // conversion. 1626 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType()) 1627 return false; 1628 1629 // Identical types require no conversions. 1630 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1631 return false; 1632 1633 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity. 1634 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) { 1635 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the 1636 // identity conversion. 1637 if (FromType->isExtVectorType()) 1638 return false; 1639 1640 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector. 1641 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) { 1642 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat; 1643 return true; 1644 } 1645 } 1646 1647 if ((ToType->isSizelessBuiltinType() || FromType->isSizelessBuiltinType()) && 1648 S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(FromType, ToType)) { 1649 ICK = ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion; 1650 return true; 1651 } 1652 1653 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases: 1654 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types 1655 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the 1656 // same size 1657 // 3)the destination type does not have the ARM MVE strict-polymorphism 1658 // attribute, which inhibits lax vector conversion for overload resolution 1659 // only 1660 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) { 1661 if (S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) || 1662 (S.isLaxVectorConversion(FromType, ToType) && 1663 !ToType->hasAttr(attr::ArmMveStrictPolymorphism))) { 1664 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion; 1665 return true; 1666 } 1667 } 1668 1669 return false; 1670 } 1671 1672 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1673 bool InOverloadResolution, 1674 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 1675 bool CStyle); 1676 1677 /// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard 1678 /// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the 1679 /// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences 1680 /// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class 1681 /// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will 1682 /// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this 1683 /// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this 1684 /// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified. 1685 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 1686 bool InOverloadResolution, 1687 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 1688 bool CStyle, 1689 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 1690 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 1691 1692 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv]) 1693 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1694 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false; 1695 SCS.setFromType(FromType); 1696 SCS.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 1697 1698 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so 1699 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit them. 1700 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 1701 (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType())) 1702 return false; 1703 1704 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, 1705 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion 1706 // (C++ 4p1). 1707 1708 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 1709 DeclAccessPair AccessPair; 1710 if (FunctionDecl *Fn 1711 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false, 1712 AccessPair)) { 1713 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function, 1714 // so we can convert to the type of that function. 1715 FromType = Fn->getType(); 1716 SCS.setFromType(FromType); 1717 1718 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check 1719 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool 1720 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType( 1721 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) { 1722 QualType resultTy; 1723 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok 1724 if (!S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType, 1725 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy)) 1726 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard 1727 if (!ToType->isBooleanType()) 1728 return false; 1729 } 1730 1731 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded 1732 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the 1733 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of 1734 // expression. 1735 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn); 1736 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) { 1737 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) && 1738 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address"); 1739 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() 1740 == UO_AddrOf && 1741 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address"); 1742 const Type *ClassType 1743 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr(); 1744 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType); 1745 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) { 1746 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() == 1747 UO_AddrOf && 1748 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression"); 1749 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 1750 } 1751 1752 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution. 1753 // FIXME: FixOverloadedFunctionReference has side-effects; we shouldn't 1754 // be calling it from within an NDEBUG block. 1755 assert(S.Context.hasSameType( 1756 FromType, 1757 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType())); 1758 } else { 1759 return false; 1760 } 1761 } 1762 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1): 1763 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can 1764 // be converted to a prvalue. 1765 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue(); 1766 if (argIsLValue && 1767 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() && 1768 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) { 1769 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue; 1770 1771 // C11 6.3.2.1p2: 1772 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version 1773 // of the type of the lvalue ... 1774 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 1775 FromType = Atomic->getValueType(); 1776 1777 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the 1778 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue 1779 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we 1780 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter. 1781 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1782 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) { 1783 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2) 1784 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer; 1785 1786 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown 1787 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to 1788 // T" (C++ 4.2p1). 1789 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 1790 1791 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) { 1792 // This conversion is deprecated in C++03 (D.4) 1793 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true; 1794 1795 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution 1796 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an 1797 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification 1798 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2) 1799 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1800 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 1801 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false; 1802 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType); 1803 return true; 1804 } 1805 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) { 1806 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3). 1807 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer; 1808 1809 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(From->IgnoreParenCasts())) 1810 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl())) 1811 if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD)) 1812 return false; 1813 1814 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of 1815 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the 1816 // function. (C++ 4.3p1). 1817 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 1818 } else { 1819 // We don't require any conversions for the first step. 1820 SCS.First = ICK_Identity; 1821 } 1822 SCS.setToType(0, FromType); 1823 1824 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating 1825 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion, 1826 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion, 1827 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1). 1828 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type" 1829 // conversion. 1830 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 1831 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity; 1832 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) { 1833 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no 1834 // conversion to do. 1835 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1836 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) { 1837 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5). 1838 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion; 1839 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1840 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 1841 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). 1842 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion; 1843 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1844 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 1845 // Complex promotion (Clang extension) 1846 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion; 1847 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1848 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() && 1849 (FromType->isArithmeticType() || 1850 FromType->isAnyPointerType() || 1851 FromType->isBlockPointerType() || 1852 FromType->isMemberPointerType())) { 1853 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12). 1854 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion; 1855 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy; 1856 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 1857 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) { 1858 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7). 1859 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion; 1860 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1861 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isAnyComplexType()) { 1862 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6) 1863 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion; 1864 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1865 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) || 1866 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) { 1867 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7) 1868 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real; 1869 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1870 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) { 1871 // FIXME: disable conversions between long double and __float128 if 1872 // their representation is different until there is back end support 1873 // We of course allow this conversion if long double is really double. 1874 1875 // Conversions between bfloat and other floats are not permitted. 1876 if (FromType == S.Context.BFloat16Ty || ToType == S.Context.BFloat16Ty) 1877 return false; 1878 if (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FromType) != 1879 &S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)) { 1880 bool Float128AndLongDouble = ((FromType == S.Context.Float128Ty && 1881 ToType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy) || 1882 (FromType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy && 1883 ToType == S.Context.Float128Ty)); 1884 if (Float128AndLongDouble && 1885 (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(S.Context.LongDoubleTy) == 1886 &llvm::APFloat::PPCDoubleDouble())) 1887 return false; 1888 } 1889 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8). 1890 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion; 1891 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1892 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() && 1893 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) || 1894 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 1895 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) { 1896 // Conversions between bfloat and int are not permitted. 1897 if (FromType->isBFloat16Type() || ToType->isBFloat16Type()) 1898 return false; 1899 1900 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9). 1901 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral; 1902 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1903 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1904 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion; 1905 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion && 1906 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1907 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion; 1908 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 1909 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 1910 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10). 1911 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion; 1912 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC; 1913 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1914 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, 1915 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) { 1916 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11). 1917 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member; 1918 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) { 1919 SCS.Second = SecondICK; 1920 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1921 } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 1922 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) { 1923 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading) 1924 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion; 1925 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1926 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, 1927 InOverloadResolution, 1928 SCS, CStyle)) { 1929 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion; 1930 FromType = ToType; 1931 } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS, 1932 CStyle)) { 1933 // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence 1934 // appropriately. 1935 return true; 1936 } else if (ToType->isEventT() && 1937 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) && 1938 From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0) { 1939 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion; 1940 FromType = ToType; 1941 } else if (ToType->isQueueT() && 1942 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) && 1943 (From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0)) { 1944 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion; 1945 FromType = ToType; 1946 } else if (ToType->isSamplerT() && 1947 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext())) { 1948 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion; 1949 FromType = ToType; 1950 } else { 1951 // No second conversion required. 1952 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1953 } 1954 SCS.setToType(1, FromType); 1955 1956 // The third conversion can be a function pointer conversion or a 1957 // qualification conversion (C++ [conv.fctptr], [conv.qual]). 1958 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion; 1959 if (S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1960 // Function pointer conversions (removing 'noexcept') including removal of 1961 // 'noreturn' (Clang extension). 1962 SCS.Third = ICK_Function_Conversion; 1963 } else if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle, 1964 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) { 1965 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 1966 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion; 1967 FromType = ToType; 1968 } else { 1969 // No conversion required 1970 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 1971 } 1972 1973 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6: 1974 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is 1975 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute 1976 // a conversion. [...] 1977 QualType CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1978 QualType CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1979 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType() 1980 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() && 1981 CanonFrom.getLocalQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalQualifiers()) { 1982 FromType = ToType; 1983 CanonFrom = CanonTo; 1984 } 1985 1986 SCS.setToType(2, FromType); 1987 1988 if (CanonFrom == CanonTo) 1989 return true; 1990 1991 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type, 1992 // this is a bad conversion sequence, unless we're resolving an overload in C. 1993 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !InOverloadResolution) 1994 return false; 1995 1996 ExprResult ER = ExprResult{From}; 1997 Sema::AssignConvertType Conv = 1998 S.CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(ToType, ER, 1999 /*Diagnose=*/false, 2000 /*DiagnoseCFAudited=*/false, 2001 /*ConvertRHS=*/false); 2002 ImplicitConversionKind SecondConv; 2003 switch (Conv) { 2004 case Sema::Compatible: 2005 SecondConv = ICK_C_Only_Conversion; 2006 break; 2007 // For our purposes, discarding qualifiers is just as bad as using an 2008 // incompatible pointer. Note that an IncompatiblePointer conversion can drop 2009 // qualifiers, as well. 2010 case Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: 2011 case Sema::IncompatiblePointer: 2012 case Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign: 2013 SecondConv = ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion; 2014 break; 2015 default: 2016 return false; 2017 } 2018 2019 // First can only be an lvalue conversion, so we pretend that this was the 2020 // second conversion. First should already be valid from earlier in the 2021 // function. 2022 SCS.Second = SecondConv; 2023 SCS.setToType(1, ToType); 2024 2025 // Third is Identity, because Second should rank us worse than any other 2026 // conversion. This could also be ICK_Qualification, but it's simpler to just 2027 // lump everything in with the second conversion, and we don't gain anything 2028 // from making this ICK_Qualification. 2029 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 2030 SCS.setToType(2, ToType); 2031 return true; 2032 } 2033 2034 static bool 2035 IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, 2036 QualType &ToType, 2037 bool InOverloadResolution, 2038 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 2039 bool CStyle) { 2040 2041 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType(); 2042 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) 2043 return false; 2044 // The field to initialize within the transparent union. 2045 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl(); 2046 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields. 2047 for (const auto *it : UD->fields()) { 2048 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS, 2049 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) { 2050 ToType = it->getType(); 2051 return true; 2052 } 2053 } 2054 return false; 2055 } 2056 2057 /// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the 2058 /// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to 2059 /// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and 2060 /// sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 2061 bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2062 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 2063 // All integers are built-in. 2064 if (!To) { 2065 return false; 2066 } 2067 2068 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or 2069 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if 2070 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise, 2071 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned 2072 // int (C++ 4.5p1). 2073 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() && 2074 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) { 2075 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int 2076 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() || 2077 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is 2078 // less than int to an int. 2079 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType))) { 2080 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 2081 } 2082 2083 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 2084 } 2085 2086 // C++11 [conv.prom]p3: 2087 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not 2088 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the 2089 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration 2090 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int, 2091 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned 2092 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the 2093 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration 2094 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type 2095 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long 2096 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If 2097 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen. 2098 // C++11 [conv.prom]p4: 2099 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed 2100 // can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if 2101 // integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an 2102 // unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be 2103 // converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type. 2104 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) { 2105 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not 2106 // provided for a scoped enumeration. 2107 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped()) 2108 return false; 2109 2110 // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum, 2111 // even if that's not the promoted type. Note that the check for promoting 2112 // the underlying type is based on the type alone, and does not consider 2113 // the bitfield-ness of the actual source expression. 2114 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) { 2115 QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 2116 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) || 2117 IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, Underlying, ToType); 2118 } 2119 2120 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial. 2121 if (ToType->isIntegerType() && 2122 isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), FromType)) 2123 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType( 2124 ToType, FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType()); 2125 2126 // C++ [conv.prom]p5: 2127 // If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any other 2128 // value of that type for promotion purposes. 2129 // 2130 // ... so do not fall through into the bit-field checks below in C++. 2131 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 2132 return false; 2133 } 2134 2135 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2: 2136 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted 2137 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can 2138 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int, 2139 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int. 2140 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its 2141 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, 2142 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying 2143 // type. 2144 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() && 2145 ToType->isIntegerType()) { 2146 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or 2147 // unsigned. 2148 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType(); 2149 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType); 2150 2151 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate 2152 // order. Try each of these types. 2153 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = { 2154 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy, 2155 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy , 2156 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy 2157 }; 2158 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) { 2159 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]); 2160 if (FromSize < ToSize || 2161 (FromSize == ToSize && 2162 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) { 2163 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the 2164 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no 2165 // promotion. 2166 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]); 2167 } 2168 } 2169 } 2170 2171 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an 2172 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the 2173 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if 2174 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If 2175 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to 2176 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any 2177 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3). 2178 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the 2179 // conversion. 2180 // 2181 // FIXME: In C, only bit-fields of types _Bool, int, or unsigned int may be 2182 // promoted, per C11 6.3.1.1/2. We promote all bit-fields (including enum 2183 // bit-fields and those whose underlying type is larger than int) for GCC 2184 // compatibility. 2185 if (From) { 2186 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getSourceBitField()) { 2187 Optional<llvm::APSInt> BitWidth; 2188 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) && 2189 (BitWidth = 2190 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context))) { 2191 llvm::APSInt ToSize(BitWidth->getBitWidth(), BitWidth->isUnsigned()); 2192 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType); 2193 2194 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int? 2195 if (*BitWidth < ToSize || 2196 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && *BitWidth <= ToSize)) { 2197 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 2198 } 2199 2200 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield 2201 // that fits into an unsigned int? 2202 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && *BitWidth <= ToSize) { 2203 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 2204 } 2205 2206 return false; 2207 } 2208 } 2209 } 2210 2211 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int, 2212 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4). 2213 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) { 2214 return true; 2215 } 2216 2217 return false; 2218 } 2219 2220 /// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from 2221 /// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so, 2222 /// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 2223 bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2224 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 2225 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 2226 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type 2227 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1). 2228 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float && 2229 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) 2230 return true; 2231 2232 // C99 6.3.1.5p1: 2233 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a 2234 // double is promoted to long double [...]. 2235 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2236 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float || 2237 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) && 2238 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble || 2239 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float128)) 2240 return true; 2241 2242 // Half can be promoted to float. 2243 if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType && 2244 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half && 2245 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float) 2246 return true; 2247 } 2248 2249 return false; 2250 } 2251 2252 /// Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion. 2253 /// 2254 /// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion 2255 /// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a 2256 /// floating-point or integral promotion. 2257 bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2258 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 2259 if (!FromComplex) 2260 return false; 2261 2262 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 2263 if (!ToComplex) 2264 return false; 2265 2266 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(), 2267 ToComplex->getElementType()) || 2268 IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, FromComplex->getElementType(), 2269 ToComplex->getElementType()); 2270 } 2271 2272 /// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from 2273 /// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the 2274 /// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType, 2275 /// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have 2276 /// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee. 2277 /// 2278 static QualType 2279 BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr, 2280 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType, 2281 ASTContext &Context, 2282 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) { 2283 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer || 2284 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) && 2285 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type"); 2286 2287 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions. 2288 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 2289 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 2290 2291 QualType CanonFromPointee 2292 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType()); 2293 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee); 2294 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers(); 2295 2296 if (StripObjCLifetime) 2297 Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 2298 2299 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to. 2300 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) { 2301 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it. 2302 if (!ToType.isNull()) 2303 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 2304 2305 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers 2306 // already. 2307 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 2308 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee); 2309 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee); 2310 } 2311 2312 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers. 2313 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee 2314 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals); 2315 2316 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 2317 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 2318 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 2319 } 2320 2321 static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr, 2322 bool InOverloadResolution, 2323 ASTContext &Context) { 2324 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly. 2325 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903 2326 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() && 2327 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType()) 2328 return !InOverloadResolution; 2329 2330 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 2331 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 2332 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 2333 } 2334 2335 /// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 2336 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, 2337 /// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++ 2338 /// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that 2339 /// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into 2340 /// ConvertedType. 2341 /// 2342 /// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers 2343 /// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and 2344 /// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the 2345 /// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to 2346 /// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however, 2347 /// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer 2348 /// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be 2349 /// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that 2350 /// should result in a warning. 2351 bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2352 bool InOverloadResolution, 2353 QualType& ConvertedType, 2354 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 2355 IncompatibleObjC = false; 2356 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType, 2357 IncompatibleObjC)) 2358 return true; 2359 2360 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type. 2361 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 2362 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2363 ConvertedType = ToType; 2364 return true; 2365 } 2366 2367 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*. 2368 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() && 2369 ToType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 2370 ConvertedType = ToType; 2371 return true; 2372 } 2373 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block 2374 // pointer type. 2375 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() && 2376 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2377 ConvertedType = ToType; 2378 return true; 2379 } 2380 2381 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null 2382 // pointer constant. 2383 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() && 2384 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2385 ConvertedType = ToType; 2386 return true; 2387 } 2388 2389 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>(); 2390 if (!ToTypePtr) 2391 return false; 2392 2393 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1). 2394 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2395 ConvertedType = ToType; 2396 return true; 2397 } 2398 2399 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers 2400 // , including objective-c pointers. 2401 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 2402 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() && 2403 !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 2404 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType( 2405 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), 2406 ToPointeeType, 2407 ToType, Context); 2408 return true; 2409 } 2410 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>(); 2411 if (!FromTypePtr) 2412 return false; 2413 2414 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 2415 2416 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a 2417 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below. 2418 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) 2419 return false; 2420 2421 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type, 2422 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++ 2423 // 4.10p2). 2424 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() && 2425 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 2426 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2427 ToPointeeType, 2428 ToType, Context, 2429 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true); 2430 return true; 2431 } 2432 2433 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion. 2434 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && 2435 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 2436 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2437 ToPointeeType, 2438 ToType, Context); 2439 return true; 2440 } 2441 2442 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer 2443 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types. 2444 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2445 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2446 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2447 ToPointeeType, 2448 ToType, Context); 2449 return true; 2450 } 2451 2452 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3: 2453 // 2454 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type, 2455 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where 2456 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible 2457 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that 2458 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the 2459 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the 2460 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to 2461 // the null pointer value of the destination type. 2462 // 2463 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility 2464 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion. 2465 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && 2466 ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 2467 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) && 2468 IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2469 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2470 ToPointeeType, 2471 ToType, Context); 2472 return true; 2473 } 2474 2475 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() && 2476 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2477 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2478 ToPointeeType, 2479 ToType, Context); 2480 return true; 2481 } 2482 2483 return false; 2484 } 2485 2486 /// Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type. 2487 static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){ 2488 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers(); 2489 2490 // Check whether qualifiers already match. 2491 if (TQs == Qs) 2492 return T; 2493 2494 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs)) 2495 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs); 2496 2497 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs); 2498 } 2499 2500 /// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an 2501 /// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion, 2502 /// with the same arguments and return values. 2503 bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2504 QualType& ConvertedType, 2505 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 2506 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC) 2507 return false; 2508 2509 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from. 2510 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers(); 2511 2512 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types. 2513 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr = 2514 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 2515 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr = 2516 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 2517 2518 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) { 2519 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications), 2520 // then this is not a pointer conversion. 2521 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2522 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 2523 return false; 2524 2525 // Conversion between Objective-C pointers. 2526 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) { 2527 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 2528 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 2529 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS && 2530 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 2531 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 2532 return false; 2533 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 2534 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2535 ToType, Context); 2536 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2537 return true; 2538 } 2539 2540 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) { 2541 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C 2542 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to 2543 // complain about it. 2544 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2545 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 2546 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2547 ToType, Context); 2548 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2549 return true; 2550 } 2551 } 2552 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers. 2553 QualType ToPointeeType; 2554 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2555 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType(); 2556 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr = 2557 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 2558 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object 2559 // to a block pointer type. 2560 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 2561 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2562 return true; 2563 } 2564 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2565 } 2566 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() && 2567 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 2568 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a 2569 // pointer to any object. 2570 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2571 return true; 2572 } 2573 else 2574 return false; 2575 2576 QualType FromPointeeType; 2577 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2578 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType(); 2579 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = 2580 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2581 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2582 else 2583 return false; 2584 2585 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this 2586 // is an Objective-C conversion. 2587 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() && 2588 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 2589 IncompatibleObjC)) { 2590 // We always complain about this conversion. 2591 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2592 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 2593 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2594 return true; 2595 } 2596 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one; 2597 // as in I* to id. 2598 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 2599 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 2600 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 2601 IncompatibleObjC)) { 2602 2603 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 2604 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2605 return true; 2606 } 2607 2608 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only 2609 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C 2610 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but 2611 // complain about it). 2612 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType 2613 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2614 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType 2615 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2616 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) { 2617 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an 2618 // Objective-C pointer conversion. 2619 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType) 2620 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType)) 2621 return false; 2622 2623 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these 2624 // function types are obviously different. 2625 if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() || 2626 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() || 2627 FromFunctionType->getMethodQuals() != ToFunctionType->getMethodQuals()) 2628 return false; 2629 2630 bool HasObjCConversion = false; 2631 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType()) == 2632 Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) { 2633 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2634 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2635 ToFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2636 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2637 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2638 HasObjCConversion = true; 2639 } else { 2640 // Function types are too different. Abort. 2641 return false; 2642 } 2643 2644 // Check argument types. 2645 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); 2646 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 2647 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2648 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2649 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType) 2650 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) { 2651 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2652 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType, 2653 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2654 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2655 HasObjCConversion = true; 2656 } else { 2657 // Argument types are too different. Abort. 2658 return false; 2659 } 2660 } 2661 2662 if (HasObjCConversion) { 2663 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer 2664 // conversion, but complain about it. 2665 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2666 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2667 return true; 2668 } 2669 } 2670 2671 return false; 2672 } 2673 2674 /// Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion, 2675 /// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting. 2676 /// 2677 /// \param FromType The type we're converting form. 2678 /// 2679 /// \param ToType The type we're converting to. 2680 /// 2681 /// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying 2682 /// this conversion. 2683 bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2684 QualType &ConvertedType) { 2685 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount || 2686 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 2687 return false; 2688 2689 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers). 2690 QualType ToPointee; 2691 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2692 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType(); 2693 else 2694 return false; 2695 2696 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers(); 2697 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() || 2698 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing || 2699 !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty()) 2700 return false; 2701 2702 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak. 2703 QualType FromPointee; 2704 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2705 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType(); 2706 else 2707 return false; 2708 2709 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers(); 2710 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() || 2711 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong && 2712 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak)) 2713 return false; 2714 2715 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers. 2716 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing); 2717 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals)) 2718 return false; 2719 2720 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they 2721 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back 2722 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds. 2723 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 2724 2725 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible. 2726 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 2727 bool IncompatibleObjC; 2728 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee)) 2729 FromPointee = ToPointee; 2730 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee, 2731 IncompatibleObjC)) 2732 return false; 2733 2734 /// Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to 2735 /// __autoreleasing pointee. 2736 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals); 2737 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee); 2738 return true; 2739 } 2740 2741 bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2742 QualType& ConvertedType) { 2743 QualType ToPointeeType; 2744 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr = 2745 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2746 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2747 else 2748 return false; 2749 2750 QualType FromPointeeType; 2751 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = 2752 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2753 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2754 else 2755 return false; 2756 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only 2757 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C 2758 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion. 2759 2760 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType 2761 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2762 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType 2763 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2764 2765 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType) 2766 return false; 2767 2768 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) 2769 return true; 2770 2771 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these 2772 // function types are obviously different. 2773 if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() || 2774 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic()) 2775 return false; 2776 2777 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo(); 2778 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo(); 2779 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo) 2780 return false; 2781 2782 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 2783 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2784 ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) { 2785 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2786 } else { 2787 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getReturnType(); 2788 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getReturnType(); 2789 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) && 2790 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers()) 2791 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType(); 2792 2793 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) { 2794 // OK exact match. 2795 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS, 2796 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2797 if (IncompatibleObjC) 2798 return false; 2799 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2800 } 2801 else 2802 return false; 2803 } 2804 2805 // Check argument types. 2806 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); 2807 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 2808 IncompatibleObjC = false; 2809 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2810 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2811 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) { 2812 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2813 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType, 2814 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2815 if (IncompatibleObjC) 2816 return false; 2817 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2818 } else 2819 // Argument types are too different. Abort. 2820 return false; 2821 } 2822 2823 SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos; 2824 bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT; 2825 if (!Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFunctionType, FromFunctionType, 2826 CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT, 2827 NewParamInfos)) 2828 return false; 2829 2830 ConvertedType = ToType; 2831 return true; 2832 } 2833 2834 enum { 2835 ft_default, 2836 ft_different_class, 2837 ft_parameter_arity, 2838 ft_parameter_mismatch, 2839 ft_return_type, 2840 ft_qualifer_mismatch, 2841 ft_noexcept 2842 }; 2843 2844 /// Attempts to get the FunctionProtoType from a Type. Handles 2845 /// MemberFunctionPointers properly. 2846 static const FunctionProtoType *tryGetFunctionProtoType(QualType FromType) { 2847 if (auto *FPT = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 2848 return FPT; 2849 2850 if (auto *MPT = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 2851 return MPT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2852 2853 return nullptr; 2854 } 2855 2856 /// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing 2857 /// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in 2858 /// parameter types, and different return types. 2859 void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag, 2860 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2861 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info. 2862 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) { 2863 PDiag << ft_default; 2864 return; 2865 } 2866 2867 // Get the function type from the pointers. 2868 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) { 2869 const auto *FromMember = FromType->castAs<MemberPointerType>(), 2870 *ToMember = ToType->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2871 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromMember->getClass(), ToMember->getClass())) { 2872 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0) 2873 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0); 2874 return; 2875 } 2876 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType(); 2877 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType(); 2878 } 2879 2880 if (FromType->isPointerType()) 2881 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType(); 2882 if (ToType->isPointerType()) 2883 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType(); 2884 2885 // Remove references. 2886 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType(); 2887 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType(); 2888 2889 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions. 2890 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() && 2891 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) { 2892 PDiag << ft_default; 2893 return; 2894 } 2895 2896 // No extra info for same types. 2897 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) { 2898 PDiag << ft_default; 2899 return; 2900 } 2901 2902 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(FromType), 2903 *ToFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(ToType); 2904 2905 // Both types need to be function types. 2906 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) { 2907 PDiag << ft_default; 2908 return; 2909 } 2910 2911 if (FromFunction->getNumParams() != ToFunction->getNumParams()) { 2912 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumParams() 2913 << FromFunction->getNumParams(); 2914 return; 2915 } 2916 2917 // Handle different parameter types. 2918 unsigned ArgPos; 2919 if (!FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) { 2920 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1 2921 << ToFunction->getParamType(ArgPos) 2922 << FromFunction->getParamType(ArgPos); 2923 return; 2924 } 2925 2926 // Handle different return type. 2927 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getReturnType(), 2928 ToFunction->getReturnType())) { 2929 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getReturnType() 2930 << FromFunction->getReturnType(); 2931 return; 2932 } 2933 2934 if (FromFunction->getMethodQuals() != ToFunction->getMethodQuals()) { 2935 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToFunction->getMethodQuals() 2936 << FromFunction->getMethodQuals(); 2937 return; 2938 } 2939 2940 // Handle exception specification differences on canonical type (in C++17 2941 // onwards). 2942 if (cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified()) 2943 ->isNothrow() != 2944 cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified()) 2945 ->isNothrow()) { 2946 PDiag << ft_noexcept; 2947 return; 2948 } 2949 2950 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info. 2951 PDiag << ft_default; 2952 } 2953 2954 /// FunctionParamTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types 2955 /// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that 2956 /// they have same number of arguments. If the parameters are different, 2957 /// ArgPos will have the parameter index of the first different parameter. 2958 bool Sema::FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType, 2959 const FunctionProtoType *NewType, 2960 unsigned *ArgPos) { 2961 for (FunctionProtoType::param_type_iterator O = OldType->param_type_begin(), 2962 N = NewType->param_type_begin(), 2963 E = OldType->param_type_end(); 2964 O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) { 2965 // Ignore address spaces in pointee type. This is to disallow overloading 2966 // on __ptr32/__ptr64 address spaces. 2967 QualType Old = Context.removePtrSizeAddrSpace(O->getUnqualifiedType()); 2968 QualType New = Context.removePtrSizeAddrSpace(N->getUnqualifiedType()); 2969 2970 if (!Context.hasSameType(Old, New)) { 2971 if (ArgPos) 2972 *ArgPos = O - OldType->param_type_begin(); 2973 return false; 2974 } 2975 } 2976 return true; 2977 } 2978 2979 /// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the 2980 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for 2981 /// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer 2982 /// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned 2983 /// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an 2984 /// error, or returns false otherwise. 2985 bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 2986 CastKind &Kind, 2987 CXXCastPath& BasePath, 2988 bool IgnoreBaseAccess, 2989 bool Diagnose) { 2990 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 2991 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess; 2992 2993 Kind = CK_BitCast; 2994 2995 if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() && 2996 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) == 2997 Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) { 2998 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy)) 2999 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From, 3000 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer) 3001 << ToType << From->getSourceRange()); 3002 else if (!isUnevaluatedContext()) 3003 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer) 3004 << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 3005 } 3006 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 3007 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 3008 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(), 3009 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType(); 3010 3011 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 3012 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 3013 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an 3014 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion. 3015 unsigned InaccessibleID = 0; 3016 unsigned AmbiguousID = 0; 3017 if (Diagnose) { 3018 InaccessibleID = diag::err_upcast_to_inaccessible_base; 3019 AmbiguousID = diag::err_ambiguous_derived_to_base_conv; 3020 } 3021 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion( 3022 FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, InaccessibleID, AmbiguousID, 3023 From->getExprLoc(), From->getSourceRange(), DeclarationName(), 3024 &BasePath, IgnoreBaseAccess)) 3025 return true; 3026 3027 // The conversion was successful. 3028 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase; 3029 } 3030 3031 if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && 3032 FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 3033 assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 3034 "this should only be possible with MSVCCompat!"); 3035 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_ms_impcast_fn_obj) 3036 << From->getSourceRange(); 3037 } 3038 } 3039 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType = 3040 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 3041 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType = 3042 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 3043 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay. 3044 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the 3045 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions. 3046 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType()) 3047 return false; 3048 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) { 3049 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 3050 } else { 3051 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 3052 } 3053 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) { 3054 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType()) 3055 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 3056 } 3057 3058 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other 3059 // reasons. 3060 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 3061 Kind = CK_NullToPointer; 3062 3063 return false; 3064 } 3065 3066 /// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 3067 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be 3068 /// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11). 3069 /// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from 3070 /// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType. 3071 bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, 3072 QualType ToType, 3073 bool InOverloadResolution, 3074 QualType &ConvertedType) { 3075 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3076 if (!ToTypePtr) 3077 return false; 3078 3079 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1) 3080 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 3081 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 3082 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 3083 ConvertedType = ToType; 3084 return true; 3085 } 3086 3087 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers. 3088 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3089 if (!FromTypePtr) 3090 return false; 3091 3092 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D, 3093 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2). 3094 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 3095 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 3096 3097 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) && 3098 IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), ToClass, FromClass)) { 3099 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(), 3100 ToClass.getTypePtr()); 3101 return true; 3102 } 3103 3104 return false; 3105 } 3106 3107 /// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the 3108 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or 3109 /// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions 3110 /// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns 3111 /// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false 3112 /// otherwise. 3113 bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3114 CastKind &Kind, 3115 CXXCastPath &BasePath, 3116 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) { 3117 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 3118 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3119 if (!FromPtrType) { 3120 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion 3121 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 3122 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) && 3123 "Expr must be null pointer constant!"); 3124 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer; 3125 return false; 3126 } 3127 3128 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 3129 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type " 3130 "that is not a member pointer."); 3131 3132 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0); 3133 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0); 3134 3135 // FIXME: What about dependent types? 3136 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 3137 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 3138 3139 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true, 3140 /*DetectVirtual=*/true); 3141 bool DerivationOkay = 3142 IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), ToClass, FromClass, Paths); 3143 assert(DerivationOkay && 3144 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK."); 3145 (void)DerivationOkay; 3146 3147 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass). 3148 getUnqualifiedType())) { 3149 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths); 3150 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv) 3151 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange(); 3152 return true; 3153 } 3154 3155 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) { 3156 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual) 3157 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0) 3158 << From->getSourceRange(); 3159 return true; 3160 } 3161 3162 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess) 3163 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass, 3164 Paths.front(), 3165 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base); 3166 3167 // Must be a base to derived member conversion. 3168 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath); 3169 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer; 3170 return false; 3171 } 3172 3173 /// Determine whether the lifetime conversion between the two given 3174 /// qualifiers sets is nontrivial. 3175 static bool isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(Qualifiers FromQuals, 3176 Qualifiers ToQuals) { 3177 // Converting anything to const __unsafe_unretained is trivial. 3178 if (ToQuals.hasConst() && 3179 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone) 3180 return false; 3181 3182 return true; 3183 } 3184 3185 /// Perform a single iteration of the loop for checking if a qualification 3186 /// conversion is valid. 3187 /// 3188 /// Specifically, check whether any change between the qualifiers of \p 3189 /// FromType and \p ToType is permissible, given knowledge about whether every 3190 /// outer layer is const-qualified. 3191 static bool isQualificationConversionStep(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 3192 bool CStyle, bool IsTopLevel, 3193 bool &PreviousToQualsIncludeConst, 3194 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) { 3195 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers(); 3196 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers(); 3197 3198 // Ignore __unaligned qualifier if this type is void. 3199 if (ToType.getUnqualifiedType()->isVoidType()) 3200 FromQuals.removeUnaligned(); 3201 3202 // Objective-C ARC: 3203 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions. 3204 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime()) { 3205 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) { 3206 if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(FromQuals, ToQuals)) 3207 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true; 3208 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime(); 3209 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime(); 3210 } else { 3211 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different 3212 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers. 3213 return false; 3214 } 3215 } 3216 3217 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes. 3218 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() && 3219 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) { 3220 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 3221 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 3222 } 3223 3224 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv 3225 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile. 3226 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals)) 3227 return false; 3228 3229 // If address spaces mismatch: 3230 // - in top level it is only valid to convert to addr space that is a 3231 // superset in all cases apart from C-style casts where we allow 3232 // conversions between overlapping address spaces. 3233 // - in non-top levels it is not a valid conversion. 3234 if (ToQuals.getAddressSpace() != FromQuals.getAddressSpace() && 3235 (!IsTopLevel || 3236 !(ToQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(FromQuals) || 3237 (CStyle && FromQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(ToQuals))))) 3238 return false; 3239 3240 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in 3241 // every cv for 0 < k < j. 3242 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers() && 3243 !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst) 3244 return false; 3245 3246 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type 3247 // include const. 3248 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = 3249 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst(); 3250 return true; 3251 } 3252 3253 /// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from 3254 /// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion 3255 /// (C++ 4.4). 3256 /// 3257 /// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate 3258 /// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C 3259 /// object lifetime. 3260 bool 3261 Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 3262 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) { 3263 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 3264 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 3265 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 3266 3267 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a 3268 // qualification conversion. 3269 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType()) 3270 return false; 3271 3272 // (C++ 4.4p4): 3273 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first 3274 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...] 3275 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true; 3276 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false; 3277 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(FromType, ToType)) { 3278 if (!isQualificationConversionStep( 3279 FromType, ToType, CStyle, !UnwrappedAnyPointer, 3280 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst, ObjCLifetimeConversion)) 3281 return false; 3282 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true; 3283 } 3284 3285 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types 3286 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number 3287 // of times. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and 3288 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked 3289 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion. 3290 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType); 3291 } 3292 3293 /// - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an 3294 /// atomic type. 3295 /// 3296 /// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion 3297 /// sequence to finish the conversion. 3298 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3299 bool InOverloadResolution, 3300 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 3301 bool CStyle) { 3302 const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>(); 3303 if (!ToAtomic) 3304 return false; 3305 3306 StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS; 3307 if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(), 3308 InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS, 3309 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) 3310 return false; 3311 3312 SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second; 3313 SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1)); 3314 SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third; 3315 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime 3316 = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime; 3317 SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2)); 3318 return true; 3319 } 3320 3321 static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context, 3322 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor, 3323 QualType Type) { 3324 const auto *CtorType = Constructor->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3325 if (CtorType->getNumParams() > 0) { 3326 QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getParamType(0); 3327 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType())) 3328 return true; 3329 } 3330 return false; 3331 } 3332 3333 static OverloadingResult 3334 IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3335 CXXRecordDecl *To, 3336 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User, 3337 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 3338 bool AllowExplicit) { 3339 CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 3340 for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(To)) { 3341 auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D); 3342 if (!Info) 3343 continue; 3344 3345 bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl() && 3346 S.isInitListConstructor(Info.Constructor); 3347 if (Usable) { 3348 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type, 3349 // suppress conversions. 3350 bool SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType( 3351 S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType); 3352 if (Info.ConstructorTmpl) 3353 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl, 3354 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, From, 3355 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 3356 /*PartialOverloading*/ false, 3357 AllowExplicit); 3358 else 3359 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl, From, 3360 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 3361 /*PartialOverloading*/ false, AllowExplicit); 3362 } 3363 } 3364 3365 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 3366 3367 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 3368 switch (auto Result = 3369 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getBeginLoc(), Best)) { 3370 case OR_Deleted: 3371 case OR_Success: { 3372 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function. 3373 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function); 3374 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(); 3375 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such. 3376 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3377 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3378 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor; 3379 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3380 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3381 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 3382 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 3383 return Result; 3384 } 3385 3386 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 3387 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 3388 case OR_Ambiguous: 3389 return OR_Ambiguous; 3390 } 3391 3392 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 3393 } 3394 3395 /// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence 3396 /// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type 3397 /// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the 3398 /// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion 3399 /// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns 3400 /// false and User is unspecified. 3401 /// 3402 /// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x 3403 /// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion 3404 /// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2). 3405 /// 3406 /// \param AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit true if the conversion should 3407 /// allow an extra Objective-C pointer conversion on uses of explicit 3408 /// constructors. Requires \c AllowExplicit to also be set. 3409 static OverloadingResult 3410 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3411 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User, 3412 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 3413 AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, 3414 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 3415 assert(AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None || 3416 !AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 3417 CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 3418 3419 // Whether we will only visit constructors. 3420 bool ConstructorsOnly = false; 3421 3422 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its 3423 // constructors. 3424 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) { 3425 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1: 3426 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or 3427 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a 3428 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the 3429 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate 3430 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of 3431 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within 3432 // the parentheses of the initializer. 3433 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) || 3434 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() && 3435 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType(), ToType))) 3436 ConstructorsOnly = true; 3437 3438 if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType)) { 3439 // We're not going to find any constructors. 3440 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl 3441 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) { 3442 3443 Expr **Args = &From; 3444 unsigned NumArgs = 1; 3445 bool ListInitializing = false; 3446 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3447 // But first, see if there is an init-list-constructor that will work. 3448 OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion( 3449 S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, 3450 AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All); 3451 if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function) 3452 return Result; 3453 // Never mind. 3454 CandidateSet.clear( 3455 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 3456 3457 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as 3458 // arguments, not the entire list. 3459 Args = InitList->getInits(); 3460 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits(); 3461 ListInitializing = true; 3462 } 3463 3464 for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl)) { 3465 auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D); 3466 if (!Info) 3467 continue; 3468 3469 bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl(); 3470 if (!ListInitializing) 3471 Usable = Usable && Info.Constructor->isConvertingConstructor( 3472 /*AllowExplicit*/ true); 3473 if (Usable) { 3474 bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly; 3475 if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) { 3476 SuppressUserConversions = false; 3477 if (NumArgs == 1) { 3478 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type, 3479 // suppress conversions. 3480 SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType( 3481 S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType); 3482 } 3483 } 3484 if (Info.ConstructorTmpl) 3485 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 3486 Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl, 3487 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 3488 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 3489 /*PartialOverloading*/ false, 3490 AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All); 3491 else 3492 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a 3493 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc). 3494 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl, 3495 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 3496 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 3497 /*PartialOverloading*/ false, 3498 AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All); 3499 } 3500 } 3501 } 3502 } 3503 3504 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to. 3505 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3506 } else if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType())) { 3507 // No conversion functions from incomplete types. 3508 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType = 3509 From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) { 3510 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl 3511 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) { 3512 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates. 3513 const auto &Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 3514 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 3515 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair(); 3516 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 3517 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 3518 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 3519 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 3520 3521 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 3522 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate; 3523 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))) 3524 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 3525 else 3526 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 3527 3528 if (ConvTemplate) 3529 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 3530 ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, 3531 CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 3532 AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None); 3533 else 3534 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, 3535 CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 3536 AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None); 3537 } 3538 } 3539 } 3540 3541 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 3542 3543 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 3544 switch (auto Result = 3545 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getBeginLoc(), Best)) { 3546 case OR_Success: 3547 case OR_Deleted: 3548 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function. 3549 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 3550 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) { 3551 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 3552 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 3553 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion 3554 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by 3555 // the argument of the constructor. 3556 // 3557 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(); 3558 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3559 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such. 3560 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3561 } else { 3562 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis()) 3563 User.EllipsisConversion = true; 3564 else { 3565 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 3566 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 3567 } 3568 } 3569 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3570 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor; 3571 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3572 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3573 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 3574 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 3575 return Result; 3576 } 3577 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion 3578 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) { 3579 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 3580 // 3581 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 3582 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard 3583 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the 3584 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function. 3585 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 3586 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3587 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 3588 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3589 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 3590 3591 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2: 3592 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the 3593 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type 3594 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence 3595 // is an initialization, the special rules for 3596 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when 3597 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a 3598 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and 3599 // 13.3.3.1). 3600 User.After = Best->FinalConversion; 3601 return Result; 3602 } 3603 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?"); 3604 3605 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 3606 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 3607 3608 case OR_Ambiguous: 3609 return OR_Ambiguous; 3610 } 3611 3612 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 3613 } 3614 3615 bool 3616 Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) { 3617 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 3618 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc(), 3619 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 3620 OverloadingResult OvResult = 3621 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, 3622 CandidateSet, AllowedExplicit::None, false); 3623 3624 if (!(OvResult == OR_Ambiguous || 3625 (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()))) 3626 return false; 3627 3628 auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates( 3629 *this, 3630 OvResult == OR_Ambiguous ? OCD_AmbiguousCandidates : OCD_AllCandidates, 3631 From); 3632 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous) 3633 Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition) 3634 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 3635 else { // OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty() 3636 if (!RequireCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType, 3637 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition_incomplete, 3638 From->getType(), From->getSourceRange())) 3639 Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition) 3640 << false << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << ToType; 3641 } 3642 3643 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 3644 *this, From, Cands); 3645 return true; 3646 } 3647 3648 // Helper for compareConversionFunctions that gets the FunctionType that the 3649 // conversion-operator return value 'points' to, or nullptr. 3650 static const FunctionType * 3651 getConversionOpReturnTyAsFunction(CXXConversionDecl *Conv) { 3652 const FunctionType *ConvFuncTy = Conv->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 3653 const PointerType *RetPtrTy = 3654 ConvFuncTy->getReturnType()->getAs<PointerType>(); 3655 3656 if (!RetPtrTy) 3657 return nullptr; 3658 3659 return RetPtrTy->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 3660 } 3661 3662 /// Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors 3663 /// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering 3664 /// is possible. 3665 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3666 compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function1, 3667 FunctionDecl *Function2) { 3668 CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1); 3669 CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2); 3670 if (!Conv1 || !Conv2) 3671 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3672 3673 if (!Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() || !Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) 3674 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3675 3676 // Objective-C++: 3677 // If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from 3678 // a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer, 3679 // respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer, 3680 // because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely 3681 // to keep code working. 3682 if (S.getLangOpts().ObjC && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 3683 bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType(); 3684 bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType(); 3685 if (Block1 != Block2) 3686 return Block1 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3687 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3688 } 3689 3690 // In order to support multiple calling conventions for the lambda conversion 3691 // operator (such as when the free and member function calling convention is 3692 // different), prefer the 'free' mechanism, followed by the calling-convention 3693 // of operator(). The latter is in place to support the MSVC-like solution of 3694 // defining ALL of the possible conversions in regards to calling-convention. 3695 const FunctionType *Conv1FuncRet = getConversionOpReturnTyAsFunction(Conv1); 3696 const FunctionType *Conv2FuncRet = getConversionOpReturnTyAsFunction(Conv2); 3697 3698 if (Conv1FuncRet && Conv2FuncRet && 3699 Conv1FuncRet->getCallConv() != Conv2FuncRet->getCallConv()) { 3700 CallingConv Conv1CC = Conv1FuncRet->getCallConv(); 3701 CallingConv Conv2CC = Conv2FuncRet->getCallConv(); 3702 3703 CXXMethodDecl *CallOp = Conv2->getParent()->getLambdaCallOperator(); 3704 const FunctionProtoType *CallOpProto = 3705 CallOp->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3706 3707 CallingConv CallOpCC = 3708 CallOp->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv(); 3709 CallingConv DefaultFree = S.Context.getDefaultCallingConvention( 3710 CallOpProto->isVariadic(), /*IsCXXMethod=*/false); 3711 CallingConv DefaultMember = S.Context.getDefaultCallingConvention( 3712 CallOpProto->isVariadic(), /*IsCXXMethod=*/true); 3713 3714 CallingConv PrefOrder[] = {DefaultFree, DefaultMember, CallOpCC}; 3715 for (CallingConv CC : PrefOrder) { 3716 if (Conv1CC == CC) 3717 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3718 if (Conv2CC == CC) 3719 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3720 } 3721 } 3722 3723 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3724 } 3725 3726 static bool hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion( 3727 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) { 3728 return (ICS.isStandard() && ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) || 3729 (ICS.isUserDefined() && 3730 ICS.UserDefined.Before.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr); 3731 } 3732 3733 /// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit 3734 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 3735 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2). 3736 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3737 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 3738 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1, 3739 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2) 3740 { 3741 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit 3742 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1) 3743 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better 3744 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or 3745 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and 3746 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better 3747 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence 3748 // (13.3.3.1.3). 3749 // 3750 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10: 3751 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as 3752 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is 3753 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable 3754 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence. 3755 3756 // String literal to 'char *' conversion has been deprecated in C++03. It has 3757 // been removed from C++11. We still accept this conversion, if it happens at 3758 // the best viable function. Otherwise, this conversion is considered worse 3759 // than ellipsis conversion. Consider this as an extension; this is not in the 3760 // standard. For example: 3761 // 3762 // int &f(...); // #1 3763 // void f(char*); // #2 3764 // void g() { int &r = f("foo"); } 3765 // 3766 // In C++03, we pick #2 as the best viable function. 3767 // In C++11, we pick #1 as the best viable function, because ellipsis 3768 // conversion is better than string-literal to char* conversion (since there 3769 // is no such conversion in C++11). If there was no #1 at all or #1 couldn't 3770 // convert arguments, #2 would be the best viable function in C++11. 3771 // If the best viable function has this conversion, a warning will be issued 3772 // in C++03, or an ExtWarn (+SFINAE failure) will be issued in C++11. 3773 3774 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings && 3775 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) != 3776 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS2)) 3777 return hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) 3778 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3779 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3780 3781 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank()) 3782 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3783 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank()) 3784 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3785 3786 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of 3787 // the same kind. 3788 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind()) 3789 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3790 3791 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result = 3792 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3793 3794 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are 3795 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the 3796 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 3797 3798 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than 3799 // list-initialization sequence L2 if: 3800 // - L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X> for some X and L2 does not, or, 3801 // if not that, 3802 // - L1 converts to type "array of N1 T", L2 converts to type "array of N2 T", 3803 // and N1 is smaller than N2., 3804 // even if one of the other rules in this paragraph would otherwise apply. 3805 if (!ICS1.isBad()) { 3806 if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() && 3807 !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement()) 3808 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3809 if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() && 3810 ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement()) 3811 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3812 } 3813 3814 if (ICS1.isStandard()) 3815 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence than 3816 // standard conversion sequence S2 if [...] 3817 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc, 3818 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard); 3819 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) { 3820 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion 3821 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if 3822 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or 3823 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of 3824 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of 3825 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 3826 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction == 3827 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction) 3828 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc, 3829 ICS1.UserDefined.After, 3830 ICS2.UserDefined.After); 3831 else 3832 Result = compareConversionFunctions(S, 3833 ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction, 3834 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction); 3835 } 3836 3837 return Result; 3838 } 3839 3840 // Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to 3841 // determine if one is a proper subset of the other. 3842 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3843 compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context, 3844 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3845 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 3846 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 3847 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3848 3849 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of 3850 // any non-identity conversion sequence 3851 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 3852 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3853 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 3854 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3855 3856 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) { 3857 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity) 3858 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3859 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity) 3860 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3861 else 3862 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3863 } else if (!Context.hasSimilarType(SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1))) 3864 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3865 3866 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) { 3867 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result 3868 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3869 } 3870 3871 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity) 3872 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3873 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 3874 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3875 3876 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity) 3877 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3878 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 3879 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3880 3881 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3882 } 3883 3884 /// Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better 3885 /// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are. 3886 static bool 3887 isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1, 3888 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) { 3889 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 3890 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an 3891 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared 3892 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference 3893 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an 3894 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue 3895 // reference*. 3896 // 3897 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits, 3898 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the 3899 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward 3900 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions. 3901 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration. 3902 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier || 3903 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier) 3904 return false; 3905 3906 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue && 3907 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) || 3908 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue && 3909 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference && SCS2.BindsToFunctionLvalue); 3910 } 3911 3912 enum class FixedEnumPromotion { 3913 None, 3914 ToUnderlyingType, 3915 ToPromotedUnderlyingType 3916 }; 3917 3918 /// Returns kind of fixed enum promotion the \a SCS uses. 3919 static FixedEnumPromotion 3920 getFixedEnumPromtion(Sema &S, const StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 3921 3922 if (SCS.Second != ICK_Integral_Promotion) 3923 return FixedEnumPromotion::None; 3924 3925 QualType FromType = SCS.getFromType(); 3926 if (!FromType->isEnumeralType()) 3927 return FixedEnumPromotion::None; 3928 3929 EnumDecl *Enum = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl(); 3930 if (!Enum->isFixed()) 3931 return FixedEnumPromotion::None; 3932 3933 QualType UnderlyingType = Enum->getIntegerType(); 3934 if (S.Context.hasSameType(SCS.getToType(1), UnderlyingType)) 3935 return FixedEnumPromotion::ToUnderlyingType; 3936 3937 return FixedEnumPromotion::ToPromotedUnderlyingType; 3938 } 3939 3940 /// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard 3941 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 3942 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 3943 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3944 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 3945 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3946 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) 3947 { 3948 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence 3949 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 3950 3951 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion 3952 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1, 3953 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion 3954 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any 3955 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that, 3956 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK 3957 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2)) 3958 return CK; 3959 3960 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules 3961 // defined below), or, if not that, 3962 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank(); 3963 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank(); 3964 if (Rank1 < Rank2) 3965 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3966 else if (Rank2 < Rank1) 3967 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3968 3969 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank 3970 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules 3971 // applies: 3972 3973 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or 3974 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion 3975 // that is such a conversion. 3976 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()) 3977 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool() 3978 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3979 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3980 3981 // C++14 [over.ics.rank]p4b2: 3982 // This is retroactively applied to C++11 by CWG 1601. 3983 // 3984 // A conversion that promotes an enumeration whose underlying type is fixed 3985 // to its underlying type is better than one that promotes to the promoted 3986 // underlying type, if the two are different. 3987 FixedEnumPromotion FEP1 = getFixedEnumPromtion(S, SCS1); 3988 FixedEnumPromotion FEP2 = getFixedEnumPromtion(S, SCS2); 3989 if (FEP1 != FixedEnumPromotion::None && FEP2 != FixedEnumPromotion::None && 3990 FEP1 != FEP2) 3991 return FEP1 == FixedEnumPromotion::ToUnderlyingType 3992 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3993 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3994 3995 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2: 3996 // 3997 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A, 3998 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to 3999 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion 4000 // of B* to void*. 4001 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid 4002 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 4003 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid 4004 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 4005 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 4006 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to 4007 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion. 4008 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4009 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4010 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 4011 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare 4012 // their derived-to-base conversions. 4013 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK 4014 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, Loc, SCS1, SCS2)) 4015 return DerivedCK; 4016 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid && 4017 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) { 4018 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void 4019 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an 4020 // inheritance relationship in their sources. 4021 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 4022 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 4023 4024 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 4025 // conversion, if we need to. 4026 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 4027 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 4028 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 4029 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 4030 4031 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4032 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4033 4034 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 4035 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4036 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 4037 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4038 4039 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the 4040 // other, it is the better one. 4041 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1 4042 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4043 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2 4044 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4045 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) { 4046 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1, 4047 FromObjCPtr2); 4048 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2, 4049 FromObjCPtr1); 4050 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) { 4051 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4052 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4053 } 4054 } 4055 } 4056 4057 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) { 4058 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings. 4059 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2)) 4060 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4061 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1)) 4062 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4063 } 4064 4065 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3, 4066 // bullet 3). 4067 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK 4068 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2)) 4069 return QualCK; 4070 4071 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) { 4072 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 4073 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to 4074 // which the references refer are the same type except for 4075 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference 4076 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type 4077 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers. 4078 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 4079 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 4080 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 4081 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 4082 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 4083 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 4084 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 4085 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 4086 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different 4087 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime. 4088 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding != 4089 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) { 4090 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding 4091 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 4092 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4093 } 4094 4095 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the 4096 // type for comparison. 4097 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 4098 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 4099 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 4100 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 4101 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) 4102 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4103 if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) 4104 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4105 } 4106 } 4107 4108 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a 4109 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion 4110 // is between types of the same size. 4111 // For example: 4112 // void f(float); 4113 // void f(int); 4114 // int main { 4115 // long a; 4116 // f(a); 4117 // } 4118 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error 4119 // as clang will do in standard mode. 4120 if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion && 4121 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral && 4122 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) == 4123 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2))) 4124 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4125 4126 // Prefer a compatible vector conversion over a lax vector conversion 4127 // For example: 4128 // 4129 // typedef float __v4sf __attribute__((__vector_size__(16))); 4130 // void f(vector float); 4131 // void f(vector signed int); 4132 // int main() { 4133 // __v4sf a; 4134 // f(a); 4135 // } 4136 // Here, we'd like to choose f(vector float) and not 4137 // report an ambiguous call error 4138 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Vector_Conversion && 4139 SCS2.Second == ICK_Vector_Conversion) { 4140 bool SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion = S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes( 4141 SCS1.getFromType(), SCS1.getToType(2)); 4142 bool SCS2IsCompatibleVectorConversion = S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes( 4143 SCS2.getFromType(), SCS2.getToType(2)); 4144 4145 if (SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion != SCS2IsCompatibleVectorConversion) 4146 return SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion 4147 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4148 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4149 } 4150 4151 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion && 4152 SCS2.Second == ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion) { 4153 bool SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion = 4154 S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS1.getToType(2)); 4155 bool SCS2IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion = 4156 S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(SCS2.getFromType(), SCS2.getToType(2)); 4157 4158 if (SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion != 4159 SCS2IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion) 4160 return SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion 4161 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4162 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4163 } 4164 4165 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4166 } 4167 4168 /// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion 4169 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 4170 /// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3). 4171 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 4172 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 4173 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 4174 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 4175 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3: 4176 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and 4177 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the 4178 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of 4179 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the 4180 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2). 4181 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second || 4182 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification) 4183 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4184 4185 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification 4186 // conversion (!) 4187 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 4188 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 4189 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 4190 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 4191 assert(!T1->isReferenceType() && !T2->isReferenceType()); 4192 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 4193 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 4194 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 4195 4196 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapping 4197 // them. 4198 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) 4199 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4200 4201 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 4202 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4203 4204 // Objective-C++ ARC: 4205 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime 4206 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime. 4207 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime != 4208 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) { 4209 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime 4210 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 4211 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4212 } 4213 4214 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2)) { 4215 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to 4216 // determine if this still looks like a qualification 4217 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of 4218 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again 4219 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left 4220 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what 4221 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a 4222 // strict subset of qualifiers. 4223 if (T1.getQualifiers().withoutObjCLifetime() == 4224 T2.getQualifiers().withoutObjCLifetime()) 4225 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything 4226 // about how the sequences rank. 4227 // ObjC ownership quals are omitted above as they interfere with 4228 // the ARC overload rule. 4229 ; 4230 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) { 4231 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 4232 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse) 4233 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 4234 // qualifiers. 4235 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4236 4237 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4238 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) { 4239 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 4240 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better) 4241 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 4242 // qualifiers. 4243 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4244 4245 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4246 } else { 4247 // Qualifiers are disjoint. 4248 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4249 } 4250 4251 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done. 4252 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2)) 4253 break; 4254 } 4255 4256 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using 4257 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion. 4258 switch (Result) { 4259 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 4260 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 4261 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4262 break; 4263 4264 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 4265 break; 4266 4267 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 4268 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 4269 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4270 break; 4271 } 4272 4273 return Result; 4274 } 4275 4276 /// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion 4277 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 4278 /// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++ 4279 /// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at 4280 /// conversions between Objective-C interface types. 4281 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 4282 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 4283 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 4284 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 4285 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 4286 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1); 4287 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 4288 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1); 4289 4290 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 4291 // conversion, if we need to. 4292 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 4293 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 4294 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 4295 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 4296 4297 // Canonicalize all of the types. 4298 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1); 4299 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1); 4300 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2); 4301 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2); 4302 4303 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3: 4304 // 4305 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and 4306 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B, 4307 // 4308 // Compare based on pointer conversions. 4309 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 4310 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 4311 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/ 4312 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() && 4313 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) { 4314 QualType FromPointee1 = 4315 FromType1->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4316 QualType ToPointee1 = 4317 ToType1->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4318 QualType FromPointee2 = 4319 FromType2->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4320 QualType ToPointee2 = 4321 ToType2->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4322 4323 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 4324 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 4325 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 4326 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4327 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 4328 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4329 } 4330 4331 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 4332 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) { 4333 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 4334 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4335 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 4336 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4337 } 4338 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 4339 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) { 4340 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1 4341 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4342 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2 4343 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4344 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1 4345 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4346 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2 4347 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4348 4349 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) { 4350 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types 4351 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the 4352 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of 4353 // Objective-C pointer types. 4354 bool FromAssignLeft 4355 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2); 4356 bool FromAssignRight 4357 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1); 4358 bool ToAssignLeft 4359 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2); 4360 bool ToAssignRight 4361 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1); 4362 4363 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id' 4364 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'. 4365 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() && 4366 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())) 4367 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4368 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() && 4369 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())) 4370 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4371 4372 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a 4373 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type 4374 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()) 4375 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4376 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()) 4377 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4378 4379 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class' 4380 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'. 4381 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() && 4382 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())) 4383 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4384 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() && 4385 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())) 4386 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4387 4388 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a 4389 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type. 4390 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()) 4391 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4392 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()) 4393 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4394 4395 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*," 4396 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) && 4397 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() && 4398 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight)) { 4399 if (FromPtr1->isSpecialized()) { 4400 // "conversion of B<A> * to B * is better than conversion of B * to 4401 // C *. 4402 bool IsFirstSame = 4403 FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl(); 4404 bool IsSecondSame = 4405 FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl(); 4406 if (IsFirstSame) { 4407 if (!IsSecondSame) 4408 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4409 } else if (IsSecondSame) 4410 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4411 } 4412 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 4413 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4414 } 4415 4416 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*," 4417 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) && 4418 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight)) 4419 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4420 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4421 } 4422 } 4423 4424 // Ranking of member-pointer types. 4425 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && 4426 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() && 4427 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) { 4428 const auto *FromMemPointer1 = FromType1->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4429 const auto *ToMemPointer1 = ToType1->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4430 const auto *FromMemPointer2 = FromType2->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4431 const auto *ToMemPointer2 = ToType2->castAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4432 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass(); 4433 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass(); 4434 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass(); 4435 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass(); 4436 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4437 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4438 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4439 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4440 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*, 4441 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 4442 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 4443 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4444 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 4445 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4446 } 4447 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::* 4448 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) { 4449 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 4450 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4451 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 4452 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4453 } 4454 } 4455 4456 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) { 4457 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A, 4458 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type 4459 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 4460 // reference of type A&, 4461 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 4462 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 4463 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType1, ToType2)) 4464 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4465 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType2, ToType1)) 4466 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4467 } 4468 4469 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A. 4470 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type 4471 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 4472 // reference of type A&, 4473 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 4474 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 4475 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType2, FromType1)) 4476 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4477 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType1, FromType2)) 4478 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4479 } 4480 } 4481 4482 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4483 } 4484 4485 /// Determine whether the given type is valid, e.g., it is not an invalid 4486 /// C++ class. 4487 static bool isTypeValid(QualType T) { 4488 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) 4489 return !Record->isInvalidDecl(); 4490 4491 return true; 4492 } 4493 4494 static QualType withoutUnaligned(ASTContext &Ctx, QualType T) { 4495 if (!T.getQualifiers().hasUnaligned()) 4496 return T; 4497 4498 Qualifiers Q; 4499 T = Ctx.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T, Q); 4500 Q.removeUnaligned(); 4501 return Ctx.getQualifiedType(T, Q); 4502 } 4503 4504 /// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to 4505 /// determine whether they are reference-compatible, 4506 /// reference-related, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by 4507 /// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference 4508 /// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference 4509 /// type being initialized. 4510 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult 4511 Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc, 4512 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2, 4513 ReferenceConversions *ConvOut) { 4514 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() && 4515 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type"); 4516 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type"); 4517 4518 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1); 4519 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2); 4520 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 4521 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 4522 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 4523 4524 ReferenceConversions ConvTmp; 4525 ReferenceConversions &Conv = ConvOut ? *ConvOut : ConvTmp; 4526 Conv = ReferenceConversions(); 4527 4528 // C++2a [dcl.init.ref]p4: 4529 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is 4530 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is similar to T2, or 4531 // T1 is a base class of T2. 4532 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if 4533 // a prvalue of type "pointer to cv2 T2" can be converted to the type 4534 // "pointer to cv1 T1" via a standard conversion sequence. 4535 4536 // Check for standard conversions we can apply to pointers: derived-to-base 4537 // conversions, ObjC pointer conversions, and function pointer conversions. 4538 // (Qualification conversions are checked last.) 4539 QualType ConvertedT2; 4540 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 4541 // Nothing to do. 4542 } else if (isCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2) && 4543 isTypeValid(UnqualT1) && isTypeValid(UnqualT2) && 4544 IsDerivedFrom(Loc, UnqualT2, UnqualT1)) 4545 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::DerivedToBase; 4546 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 4547 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 4548 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2)) 4549 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::ObjC; 4550 else if (UnqualT2->isFunctionType() && 4551 IsFunctionConversion(UnqualT2, UnqualT1, ConvertedT2)) { 4552 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::Function; 4553 // No need to check qualifiers; function types don't have them. 4554 return Ref_Compatible; 4555 } 4556 bool ConvertedReferent = Conv != 0; 4557 4558 // We can have a qualification conversion. Compute whether the types are 4559 // similar at the same time. 4560 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true; 4561 bool TopLevel = true; 4562 do { 4563 if (T1 == T2) 4564 break; 4565 4566 // We will need a qualification conversion. 4567 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::Qualification; 4568 4569 // Track whether we performed a qualification conversion anywhere other 4570 // than the top level. This matters for ranking reference bindings in 4571 // overload resolution. 4572 if (!TopLevel) 4573 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::NestedQualification; 4574 4575 // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same. 4576 T1 = withoutUnaligned(Context, T1); 4577 T2 = withoutUnaligned(Context, T2); 4578 4579 // If we find a qualifier mismatch, the types are not reference-compatible, 4580 // but are still be reference-related if they're similar. 4581 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 4582 if (!isQualificationConversionStep(T2, T1, /*CStyle=*/false, TopLevel, 4583 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst, 4584 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) 4585 return (ConvertedReferent || Context.hasSimilarType(T1, T2)) 4586 ? Ref_Related 4587 : Ref_Incompatible; 4588 4589 // FIXME: Should we track this for any level other than the first? 4590 if (ObjCLifetimeConversion) 4591 Conv |= ReferenceConversions::ObjCLifetime; 4592 4593 TopLevel = false; 4594 } while (Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2)); 4595 4596 // At this point, if the types are reference-related, we must either have the 4597 // same inner type (ignoring qualifiers), or must have already worked out how 4598 // to convert the referent. 4599 return (ConvertedReferent || Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2)) 4600 ? Ref_Compatible 4601 : Ref_Incompatible; 4602 } 4603 4604 /// Look for a user-defined conversion to a value reference-compatible 4605 /// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found. 4606 static bool 4607 FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS, 4608 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc, 4609 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues, 4610 bool AllowExplicit) { 4611 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types."); 4612 auto *T2RecordDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 4613 4614 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet( 4615 DeclLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 4616 const auto &Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 4617 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 4618 NamedDecl *D = *I; 4619 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 4620 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 4621 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 4622 4623 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate 4624 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 4625 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 4626 if (ConvTemplate) 4627 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 4628 else 4629 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 4630 4631 if (AllowRvalues) { 4632 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion 4633 // functions that return lvalues. 4634 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) { 4635 const ReferenceType *RefType 4636 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>(); 4637 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) 4638 continue; 4639 } 4640 4641 if (!ConvTemplate && 4642 S.CompareReferenceRelationship( 4643 DeclLoc, 4644 Conv->getConversionType() 4645 .getNonReferenceType() 4646 .getUnqualifiedType(), 4647 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType()) == 4648 Sema::Ref_Incompatible) 4649 continue; 4650 } else { 4651 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type, 4652 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference 4653 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type. 4654 4655 const ReferenceType *RefType = 4656 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>(); 4657 if (!RefType || 4658 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() && 4659 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())) 4660 continue; 4661 } 4662 4663 if (ConvTemplate) 4664 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 4665 ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, DeclType, CandidateSet, 4666 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, AllowExplicit); 4667 else 4668 S.AddConversionCandidate( 4669 Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, DeclType, CandidateSet, 4670 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, AllowExplicit); 4671 } 4672 4673 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 4674 4675 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 4676 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best)) { 4677 case OR_Success: 4678 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 4679 // 4680 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of 4681 // applying a conversion function to the argument 4682 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a 4683 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the 4684 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity 4685 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an 4686 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter 4687 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion. 4688 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding) 4689 return false; 4690 4691 ICS.setUserDefined(); 4692 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 4693 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion; 4694 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 4695 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function; 4696 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 4697 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 4698 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding && 4699 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding && 4700 "Expected a direct reference binding!"); 4701 return true; 4702 4703 case OR_Ambiguous: 4704 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 4705 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(); 4706 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand) 4707 if (Cand->Best) 4708 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function); 4709 return true; 4710 4711 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 4712 case OR_Deleted: 4713 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted 4714 // conversion; continue with other checks. 4715 return false; 4716 } 4717 4718 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 4719 } 4720 4721 /// Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference 4722 /// initialization. 4723 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4724 TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType, 4725 SourceLocation DeclLoc, 4726 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4727 bool AllowExplicit) { 4728 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference"); 4729 4730 // Most paths end in a failed conversion. 4731 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 4732 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 4733 4734 QualType T1 = DeclType->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 4735 QualType T2 = Init->getType(); 4736 4737 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try 4738 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the 4739 // type of the resulting function. 4740 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 4741 DeclAccessPair Found; 4742 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType, 4743 false, Found)) 4744 T2 = Fn->getType(); 4745 } 4746 4747 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer. 4748 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType(); 4749 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context); 4750 4751 Sema::ReferenceConversions RefConv; 4752 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship = 4753 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, &RefConv); 4754 4755 auto SetAsReferenceBinding = [&](bool BindsDirectly) { 4756 ICS.setStandard(); 4757 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity; 4758 // FIXME: A reference binding can be a function conversion too. We should 4759 // consider that when ordering reference-to-function bindings. 4760 ICS.Standard.Second = (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::DerivedToBase) 4761 ? ICK_Derived_To_Base 4762 : (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::ObjC) 4763 ? ICK_Compatible_Conversion 4764 : ICK_Identity; 4765 // FIXME: As a speculative fix to a defect introduced by CWG2352, we rank 4766 // a reference binding that performs a non-top-level qualification 4767 // conversion as a qualification conversion, not as an identity conversion. 4768 ICS.Standard.Third = (RefConv & 4769 Sema::ReferenceConversions::NestedQualification) 4770 ? ICK_Qualification 4771 : ICK_Identity; 4772 ICS.Standard.setFromType(T2); 4773 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2); 4774 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1); 4775 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1); 4776 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4777 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = BindsDirectly; 4778 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4779 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType(); 4780 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue(); 4781 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4782 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = 4783 (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::ObjCLifetime) != 0; 4784 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 4785 ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 4786 }; 4787 4788 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5: 4789 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression 4790 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows: 4791 4792 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression 4793 if (!isRValRef) { 4794 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is 4795 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or 4796 // 4797 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here. 4798 if (InitCategory.isLValue() && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible) { 4799 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 4800 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3) 4801 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence 4802 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression 4803 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type, 4804 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a 4805 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1). 4806 SetAsReferenceBinding(/*BindsDirectly=*/true); 4807 4808 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for 4809 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're 4810 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++ 4811 // [over.best.ics]p2). 4812 return ICS; 4813 } 4814 4815 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is 4816 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly 4817 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1" 4818 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this 4819 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable 4820 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best 4821 // one through overload resolution (13.3)), 4822 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() && 4823 S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) && 4824 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) { 4825 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 4826 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false, 4827 AllowExplicit)) 4828 return ICS; 4829 } 4830 } 4831 4832 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a 4833 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference 4834 // shall be an rvalue reference. 4835 if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified())) 4836 return ICS; 4837 4838 // -- If the initializer expression 4839 // 4840 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function 4841 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or 4842 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible && 4843 (InitCategory.isXValue() || 4844 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && 4845 (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) || 4846 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) { 4847 // In C++11, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct 4848 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue. 4849 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we 4850 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of 4851 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here. 4852 SetAsReferenceBinding(/*BindsDirectly=*/S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 || 4853 !(InitCategory.isPRValue() || T2->isRecordType())); 4854 return ICS; 4855 } 4856 4857 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not 4858 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to 4859 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type 4860 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with 4861 // "cv3 T3", 4862 // 4863 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer 4864 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion 4865 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base 4866 // class subobject). 4867 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 4868 T2->isRecordType() && S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) && 4869 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 4870 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true, 4871 AllowExplicit)) { 4872 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference 4873 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the 4874 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue 4875 // conversion, the program is ill-formed. 4876 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef && 4877 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) 4878 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 4879 4880 return ICS; 4881 } 4882 4883 // A temporary of function type cannot be created; don't even try. 4884 if (T1->isFunctionType()) 4885 return ICS; 4886 4887 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and 4888 // initialized from the initializer expression using the 4889 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The 4890 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is 4891 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same 4892 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than, 4893 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed. 4894 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) { 4895 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then 4896 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with 4897 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference 4898 // initialization fails. 4899 // 4900 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here. 4901 // ObjC GC, lifetime and unaligned qualifiers aren't important. 4902 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers(); 4903 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers(); 4904 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 4905 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4906 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 4907 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4908 // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same. 4909 T1Quals.removeUnaligned(); 4910 T2Quals.removeUnaligned(); 4911 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals)) 4912 return ICS; 4913 } 4914 4915 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not 4916 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the 4917 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking 4918 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to 4919 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor. 4920 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 4921 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType())) 4922 return ICS; 4923 4924 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue 4925 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue. 4926 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related && 4927 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue()) 4928 return ICS; 4929 4930 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2: 4931 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to 4932 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one 4933 // required to convert the argument expression to the 4934 // underlying type of the reference according to 4935 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds 4936 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with 4937 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level 4938 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself 4939 // and does not constitute a conversion. 4940 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions, 4941 AllowedExplicit::None, 4942 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 4943 /*CStyle=*/false, 4944 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 4945 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 4946 4947 // Of course, that's still a reference binding. 4948 if (ICS.isStandard()) { 4949 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4950 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4951 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4952 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true; 4953 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4954 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4955 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) { 4956 const ReferenceType *LValRefType = 4957 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getReturnType() 4958 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>(); 4959 4960 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p3: 4961 // Except for an implicit object parameter, for which see 13.3.1, a 4962 // standard conversion sequence cannot be formed if it requires [...] 4963 // binding an rvalue reference to an lvalue other than a function 4964 // lvalue. 4965 // Note that the function case is not possible here. 4966 if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType() && LValRefType) { 4967 // FIXME: This is the wrong BadConversionSequence. The problem is binding 4968 // an rvalue reference to a (non-function) lvalue, not binding an lvalue 4969 // reference to an rvalue! 4970 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init, DeclType); 4971 return ICS; 4972 } 4973 4974 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true; 4975 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4976 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4977 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = !LValRefType; 4978 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4979 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4980 } 4981 4982 return ICS; 4983 } 4984 4985 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4986 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 4987 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4988 bool InOverloadResolution, 4989 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 4990 bool AllowExplicit = false); 4991 4992 /// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the 4993 /// initializer list From. 4994 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4995 TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType, 4996 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4997 bool InOverloadResolution, 4998 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 4999 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1: 5000 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and 5001 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type. 5002 5003 ImplicitConversionSequence Result; 5004 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 5005 5006 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be 5007 // initialized from init lists. 5008 if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType)) 5009 return Result; 5010 5011 // Per DR1467: 5012 // If the parameter type is a class X and the initializer list has a single 5013 // element of type cv U, where U is X or a class derived from X, the 5014 // implicit conversion sequence is the one required to convert the element 5015 // to the parameter type. 5016 // 5017 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is a character array [... ] 5018 // and the initializer list has a single element that is an 5019 // appropriately-typed string literal (8.5.2 [dcl.init.string]), the 5020 // implicit conversion sequence is the identity conversion. 5021 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) { 5022 if (ToType->isRecordType()) { 5023 QualType InitType = From->getInit(0)->getType(); 5024 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(InitType, ToType) || 5025 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), InitType, ToType)) 5026 return TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType, 5027 SuppressUserConversions, 5028 InOverloadResolution, 5029 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5030 } 5031 5032 if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)) { 5033 if (S.IsStringInit(From->getInit(0), AT)) { 5034 InitializedEntity Entity = 5035 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType, 5036 /*Consumed=*/false); 5037 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) { 5038 Result.setStandard(); 5039 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5040 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 5041 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 5042 return Result; 5043 } 5044 } 5045 } 5046 } 5047 5048 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p2: Otherwise, if the parameter type [...] (below). 5049 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2: 5050 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and 5051 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit 5052 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an 5053 // element of the list to X. 5054 // 5055 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p3: 5056 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is "array of N X", if the initializer 5057 // list has exactly N elements or if it has fewer than N elements and X is 5058 // default-constructible, and if all the elements of the initializer list 5059 // can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit conversion sequence is 5060 // the worst conversion necessary to convert an element of the list to X. 5061 // 5062 // FIXME: We're missing a lot of these checks. 5063 bool toStdInitializerList = false; 5064 QualType X; 5065 if (ToType->isArrayType()) 5066 X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType(); 5067 else 5068 toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X); 5069 if (!X.isNull()) { 5070 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) { 5071 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i); 5072 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5073 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions, 5074 InOverloadResolution, 5075 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5076 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail. 5077 if (ICS.isBad()) { 5078 Result = ICS; 5079 break; 5080 } 5081 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion. 5082 if (Result.isBad() || CompareImplicitConversionSequences( 5083 S, From->getBeginLoc(), ICS, Result) == 5084 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse) 5085 Result = ICS; 5086 } 5087 5088 // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence. 5089 // Introduce the identity conversion sequence. 5090 if (From->getNumInits() == 0) { 5091 Result.setStandard(); 5092 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5093 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 5094 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 5095 } 5096 5097 Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList); 5098 return Result; 5099 } 5100 5101 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p4: 5102 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3: 5103 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload 5104 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit 5105 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple 5106 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the 5107 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. 5108 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) { 5109 // This function can deal with initializer lists. 5110 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 5111 AllowedExplicit::None, 5112 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false, 5113 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 5114 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5115 } 5116 5117 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p5: 5118 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4: 5119 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be 5120 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion 5121 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. 5122 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) { 5123 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes 5124 // down to checking whether the initialization works. 5125 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not. 5126 InitializedEntity Entity = 5127 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType, 5128 /*Consumed=*/false); 5129 if (S.CanPerformAggregateInitializationForOverloadResolution(Entity, 5130 From)) { 5131 Result.setUserDefined(); 5132 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5133 // Initializer lists don't have a type. 5134 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType()); 5135 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType()); 5136 5137 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5138 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType); 5139 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 5140 Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = nullptr; 5141 } 5142 return Result; 5143 } 5144 5145 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p6: 5146 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5: 5147 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4. 5148 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) { 5149 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't 5150 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list- 5151 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that. 5152 5153 QualType T1 = ToType->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 5154 5155 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related 5156 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that. 5157 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) { 5158 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0); 5159 5160 QualType T2 = Init->getType(); 5161 5162 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try 5163 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the 5164 // type of the resulting function. 5165 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 5166 DeclAccessPair Found; 5167 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction( 5168 Init, ToType, false, Found)) 5169 T2 = Fn->getType(); 5170 } 5171 5172 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer. 5173 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship = 5174 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getBeginLoc(), T1, T2); 5175 5176 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related) { 5177 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType, /*FIXME*/ From->getBeginLoc(), 5178 SuppressUserConversions, 5179 /*AllowExplicit=*/false); 5180 } 5181 } 5182 5183 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the 5184 // initializer list. 5185 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions, 5186 InOverloadResolution, 5187 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5188 if (Result.isFailure()) 5189 return Result; 5190 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() && 5191 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion."); 5192 5193 // Can we even bind to a temporary? 5194 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() || 5195 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) { 5196 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard : 5197 Result.UserDefined.After; 5198 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true; 5199 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType(); 5200 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true; 5201 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 5202 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 5203 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 5204 } else 5205 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, 5206 From, ToType); 5207 return Result; 5208 } 5209 5210 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p7: 5211 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6: 5212 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class: 5213 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) { 5214 // - if the initializer list has one element that is not itself an 5215 // initializer list, the implicit conversion sequence is the one 5216 // required to convert the element to the parameter type. 5217 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits(); 5218 if (NumInits == 1 && !isa<InitListExpr>(From->getInit(0))) 5219 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType, 5220 SuppressUserConversions, 5221 InOverloadResolution, 5222 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5223 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion 5224 // sequence is the identity conversion. 5225 else if (NumInits == 0) { 5226 Result.setStandard(); 5227 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5228 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 5229 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 5230 } 5231 return Result; 5232 } 5233 5234 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p8: 5235 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7: 5236 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible 5237 return Result; 5238 } 5239 5240 /// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type 5241 /// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion 5242 /// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad 5243 /// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to 5244 /// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we 5245 /// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences. 5246 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5247 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 5248 bool SuppressUserConversions, 5249 bool InOverloadResolution, 5250 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 5251 bool AllowExplicit) { 5252 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) 5253 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 5254 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 5255 5256 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) 5257 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType, 5258 /*FIXME:*/ From->getBeginLoc(), 5259 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit); 5260 5261 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType, 5262 SuppressUserConversions, 5263 AllowedExplicit::None, 5264 InOverloadResolution, 5265 /*CStyle=*/false, 5266 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 5267 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5268 } 5269 5270 static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy, 5271 const CanQualType ToQTy, 5272 Sema &S, 5273 SourceLocation Loc, 5274 ExprValueKind FromVK) { 5275 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK); 5276 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5277 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false); 5278 5279 return !ICS.isBad(); 5280 } 5281 5282 /// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object 5283 /// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the 5284 /// expression @p From. 5285 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5286 TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType FromType, 5287 Expr::Classification FromClassification, 5288 CXXMethodDecl *Method, 5289 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) { 5290 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext); 5291 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or 5292 // const volatile object. 5293 Qualifiers Quals = Method->getMethodQualifiers(); 5294 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method)) { 5295 Quals.addConst(); 5296 Quals.addVolatile(); 5297 } 5298 5299 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals); 5300 5301 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us 5302 // to exit early. 5303 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 5304 5305 // We need to have an object of class type. 5306 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 5307 FromType = PT->getPointeeType(); 5308 5309 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we 5310 // better have an lvalue. 5311 assert(FromClassification.isLValue()); 5312 } 5313 5314 assert(FromType->isRecordType()); 5315 5316 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4: 5317 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object 5318 // parameter is 5319 // 5320 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a 5321 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier 5322 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the && 5323 // ref-qualifier 5324 // 5325 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the 5326 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration. 5327 // 5328 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we 5329 // are not allowed to perform user-defined conversions 5330 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of 5331 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to 5332 // non-constant references. 5333 5334 // First check the qualifiers. 5335 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 5336 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers() 5337 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() && 5338 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) { 5339 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers, 5340 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 5341 return ICS; 5342 } 5343 5344 if (FromTypeCanon.hasAddressSpace()) { 5345 Qualifiers QualsImplicitParamType = ImplicitParamType.getQualifiers(); 5346 Qualifiers QualsFromType = FromTypeCanon.getQualifiers(); 5347 if (!QualsImplicitParamType.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(QualsFromType)) { 5348 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers, 5349 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 5350 return ICS; 5351 } 5352 } 5353 5354 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It 5355 // affects the conversion rank. 5356 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType); 5357 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind; 5358 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) { 5359 SecondKind = ICK_Identity; 5360 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType, ClassType)) 5361 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 5362 else { 5363 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class, 5364 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 5365 return ICS; 5366 } 5367 5368 // Check the ref-qualifier. 5369 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) { 5370 case RQ_None: 5371 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness. 5372 break; 5373 5374 case RQ_LValue: 5375 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && !Quals.hasOnlyConst()) { 5376 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue 5377 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType, 5378 ImplicitParamType); 5379 return ICS; 5380 } 5381 break; 5382 5383 case RQ_RValue: 5384 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) { 5385 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue 5386 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType, 5387 ImplicitParamType); 5388 return ICS; 5389 } 5390 break; 5391 } 5392 5393 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding. 5394 ICS.setStandard(); 5395 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5396 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind; 5397 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 5398 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType); 5399 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 5400 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true; 5401 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue; 5402 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 5403 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue(); 5404 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier 5405 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None); 5406 return ICS; 5407 } 5408 5409 /// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of 5410 /// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given 5411 /// expression. 5412 ExprResult 5413 Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From, 5414 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier, 5415 NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 5416 CXXMethodDecl *Method) { 5417 QualType FromRecordType, DestType; 5418 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType = 5419 Method->getThisType()->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5420 5421 Expr::Classification FromClassification; 5422 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 5423 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType(); 5424 DestType = Method->getThisType(); 5425 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(); 5426 } else { 5427 FromRecordType = From->getType(); 5428 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType; 5429 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context); 5430 5431 // When performing member access on an rvalue, materialize a temporary. 5432 if (From->isRValue()) { 5433 From = CreateMaterializeTemporaryExpr(FromRecordType, From, 5434 Method->getRefQualifier() != 5435 RefQualifierKind::RQ_RValue); 5436 } 5437 } 5438 5439 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing 5440 // the actual argument initialization. 5441 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 5442 *this, From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType(), FromClassification, Method, 5443 Method->getParent()); 5444 if (ICS.isBad()) { 5445 switch (ICS.Bad.Kind) { 5446 case BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers: { 5447 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers(); 5448 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers(); 5449 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 5450 if (CVR) { 5451 Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr) 5452 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1) 5453 << From->getSourceRange(); 5454 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 5455 << Method->getDeclName(); 5456 return ExprError(); 5457 } 5458 break; 5459 } 5460 5461 case BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue: 5462 case BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue: { 5463 bool IsRValueQualified = 5464 Method->getRefQualifier() == RefQualifierKind::RQ_RValue; 5465 Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_ref) 5466 << Method->getDeclName() << FromClassification.isRValue() 5467 << IsRValueQualified; 5468 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 5469 << Method->getDeclName(); 5470 return ExprError(); 5471 } 5472 5473 case BadConversionSequence::no_conversion: 5474 case BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class: 5475 break; 5476 } 5477 5478 return Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_type) 5479 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType 5480 << From->getSourceRange(); 5481 } 5482 5483 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) { 5484 ExprResult FromRes = 5485 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method); 5486 if (FromRes.isInvalid()) 5487 return ExprError(); 5488 From = FromRes.get(); 5489 } 5490 5491 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType)) { 5492 CastKind CK; 5493 QualType PteeTy = DestType->getPointeeType(); 5494 LangAS DestAS = 5495 PteeTy.isNull() ? DestType.getAddressSpace() : PteeTy.getAddressSpace(); 5496 if (FromRecordType.getAddressSpace() != DestAS) 5497 CK = CK_AddressSpaceConversion; 5498 else 5499 CK = CK_NoOp; 5500 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK, From->getValueKind()).get(); 5501 } 5502 return From; 5503 } 5504 5505 /// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the 5506 /// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 5507 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5508 TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 5509 // C++ [dcl.init]/17.8: 5510 // - Otherwise, if the initialization is direct-initialization, the source 5511 // type is std::nullptr_t, and the destination type is bool, the initial 5512 // value of the object being initialized is false. 5513 if (From->getType()->isNullPtrType()) 5514 return ImplicitConversionSequence::getNullptrToBool(From->getType(), 5515 S.Context.BoolTy, 5516 From->isGLValue()); 5517 5518 // All other direct-initialization of bool is equivalent to an implicit 5519 // conversion to bool in which explicit conversions are permitted. 5520 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy, 5521 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5522 AllowedExplicit::Conversions, 5523 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5524 /*CStyle=*/false, 5525 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 5526 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5527 } 5528 5529 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion 5530 /// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 5531 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) { 5532 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 5533 return ExprError(); 5534 5535 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From); 5536 if (!ICS.isBad()) 5537 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting); 5538 5539 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy)) 5540 return Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition) 5541 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange(); 5542 return ExprError(); 5543 } 5544 5545 /// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant 5546 /// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion 5547 /// is acceptable. 5548 static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S, 5549 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 5550 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration 5551 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third 5552 // conversions are fine. 5553 switch (SCS.Second) { 5554 case ICK_Identity: 5555 case ICK_Integral_Promotion: 5556 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: // Narrowing conversions are checked elsewhere. 5557 case ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion: 5558 return true; 5559 5560 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: 5561 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is 5562 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also arguably an integral 5563 // conversion, so we allow it in a converted constant expression. 5564 // 5565 // FIXME: Per core issue 1407, we should not allow this, but that breaks 5566 // a lot of popular code. We should at least add a warning for this 5567 // (non-conforming) extension. 5568 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 5569 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType(); 5570 5571 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion: 5572 case ICK_Pointer_Member: 5573 // C++1z: null pointer conversions and null member pointer conversions are 5574 // only permitted if the source type is std::nullptr_t. 5575 return SCS.getFromType()->isNullPtrType(); 5576 5577 case ICK_Floating_Promotion: 5578 case ICK_Complex_Promotion: 5579 case ICK_Floating_Conversion: 5580 case ICK_Complex_Conversion: 5581 case ICK_Floating_Integral: 5582 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion: 5583 case ICK_Derived_To_Base: 5584 case ICK_Vector_Conversion: 5585 case ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion: 5586 case ICK_Vector_Splat: 5587 case ICK_Complex_Real: 5588 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion: 5589 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion: 5590 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion: 5591 case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion: 5592 case ICK_C_Only_Conversion: 5593 case ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion: 5594 return false; 5595 5596 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue: 5597 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer: 5598 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer: 5599 llvm_unreachable("found a first conversion kind in Second"); 5600 5601 case ICK_Function_Conversion: 5602 case ICK_Qualification: 5603 llvm_unreachable("found a third conversion kind in Second"); 5604 5605 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds: 5606 break; 5607 } 5608 5609 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind"); 5610 } 5611 5612 /// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a 5613 /// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce 5614 /// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3. 5615 static ExprResult CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Sema &S, Expr *From, 5616 QualType T, APValue &Value, 5617 Sema::CCEKind CCE, 5618 bool RequireInt, 5619 NamedDecl *Dest) { 5620 assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && 5621 "converted constant expression outside C++11"); 5622 5623 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, From)) 5624 return ExprError(); 5625 5626 // C++1z [expr.const]p3: 5627 // A converted constant expression of type T is an expression, 5628 // implicitly converted to type T, where the converted 5629 // expression is a constant expression and the implicit conversion 5630 // sequence contains only [... list of conversions ...]. 5631 // C++1z [stmt.if]p2: 5632 // If the if statement is of the form if constexpr, the value of the 5633 // condition shall be a contextually converted constant expression of type 5634 // bool. 5635 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5636 CCE == Sema::CCEK_ConstexprIf || CCE == Sema::CCEK_ExplicitBool 5637 ? TryContextuallyConvertToBool(S, From) 5638 : TryCopyInitialization(S, From, T, 5639 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5640 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5641 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 5642 /*AllowExplicit=*/false); 5643 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = nullptr; 5644 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 5645 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 5646 SCS = &ICS.Standard; 5647 break; 5648 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion: 5649 if (T->isRecordType()) 5650 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.Before; 5651 else 5652 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After; 5653 break; 5654 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion: 5655 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 5656 if (!S.DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T)) 5657 return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), 5658 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression) 5659 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5660 return ExprError(); 5661 5662 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion: 5663 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression"); 5664 } 5665 5666 // Check that we would only use permitted conversions. 5667 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(S, *SCS)) { 5668 return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), 5669 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed) 5670 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5671 } 5672 // [...] and where the reference binding (if any) binds directly. 5673 if (SCS->ReferenceBinding && !SCS->DirectBinding) { 5674 return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), 5675 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_indirect) 5676 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5677 } 5678 5679 // Usually we can simply apply the ImplicitConversionSequence we formed 5680 // earlier, but that's not guaranteed to work when initializing an object of 5681 // class type. 5682 ExprResult Result; 5683 if (T->isRecordType()) { 5684 assert(CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg && 5685 "unexpected class type converted constant expr"); 5686 Result = S.PerformCopyInitialization( 5687 InitializedEntity::InitializeTemplateParameter( 5688 T, cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(Dest)), 5689 SourceLocation(), From); 5690 } else { 5691 Result = S.PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, Sema::AA_Converting); 5692 } 5693 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5694 return Result; 5695 5696 // C++2a [intro.execution]p5: 5697 // A full-expression is [...] a constant-expression [...] 5698 Result = 5699 S.ActOnFinishFullExpr(Result.get(), From->getExprLoc(), 5700 /*DiscardedValue=*/false, /*IsConstexpr=*/true); 5701 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5702 return Result; 5703 5704 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion. 5705 bool ReturnPreNarrowingValue = false; 5706 APValue PreNarrowingValue; 5707 QualType PreNarrowingType; 5708 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(S.Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue, 5709 PreNarrowingType)) { 5710 case NK_Dependent_Narrowing: 5711 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, but the expression is 5712 // value-dependent so we can't tell whether it's actually narrowing. 5713 case NK_Variable_Narrowing: 5714 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant 5715 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment. 5716 case NK_Not_Narrowing: 5717 break; 5718 5719 case NK_Constant_Narrowing: 5720 if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_ArrayBound && 5721 PreNarrowingType->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && 5722 PreNarrowingValue.isInt()) { 5723 // Don't diagnose array bound narrowing here; we produce more precise 5724 // errors by allowing the un-narrowed value through. 5725 ReturnPreNarrowingValue = true; 5726 break; 5727 } 5728 S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing) 5729 << CCE << /*Constant*/ 1 5730 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(S.Context, PreNarrowingType) << T; 5731 break; 5732 5733 case NK_Type_Narrowing: 5734 // FIXME: It would be better to diagnose that the expression is not a 5735 // constant expression. 5736 S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing) 5737 << CCE << /*Constant*/ 0 << From->getType() << T; 5738 break; 5739 } 5740 5741 if (Result.get()->isValueDependent()) { 5742 Value = APValue(); 5743 return Result; 5744 } 5745 5746 // Check the expression is a constant expression. 5747 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 5748 Expr::EvalResult Eval; 5749 Eval.Diag = &Notes; 5750 5751 ConstantExprKind Kind; 5752 if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg && T->isRecordType()) 5753 Kind = ConstantExprKind::ClassTemplateArgument; 5754 else if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg) 5755 Kind = ConstantExprKind::NonClassTemplateArgument; 5756 else 5757 Kind = ConstantExprKind::Normal; 5758 5759 if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsConstantExpr(Eval, S.Context, Kind) || 5760 (RequireInt && !Eval.Val.isInt())) { 5761 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in 5762 // the AST. 5763 Result = ExprError(); 5764 } else { 5765 Value = Eval.Val; 5766 5767 if (Notes.empty()) { 5768 // It's a constant expression. 5769 Expr *E = ConstantExpr::Create(S.Context, Result.get(), Value); 5770 if (ReturnPreNarrowingValue) 5771 Value = std::move(PreNarrowingValue); 5772 return E; 5773 } 5774 } 5775 5776 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic. 5777 if (Notes.size() == 1 && 5778 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) { 5779 S.Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE; 5780 } else if (!Notes.empty() && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == 5781 diag::note_constexpr_invalid_template_arg) { 5782 Notes[0].second.setDiagID(diag::err_constexpr_invalid_template_arg); 5783 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I) 5784 S.Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 5785 } else { 5786 S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_cce) 5787 << CCE << From->getSourceRange(); 5788 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I) 5789 S.Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 5790 } 5791 return ExprError(); 5792 } 5793 5794 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T, 5795 APValue &Value, CCEKind CCE, 5796 NamedDecl *Dest) { 5797 return ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, Value, CCE, false, 5798 Dest); 5799 } 5800 5801 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T, 5802 llvm::APSInt &Value, 5803 CCEKind CCE) { 5804 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type"); 5805 5806 APValue V; 5807 auto R = ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, V, CCE, true, 5808 /*Dest=*/nullptr); 5809 if (!R.isInvalid() && !R.get()->isValueDependent()) 5810 Value = V.getInt(); 5811 return R; 5812 } 5813 5814 5815 /// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence 5816 /// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change 5817 /// the result type of the conversion sequence. 5818 static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 5819 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) { 5820 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 5821 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 5822 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0]; 5823 } 5824 } 5825 5826 /// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually 5827 /// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type. 5828 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5829 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 5830 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'. 5831 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType(); 5832 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS 5833 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty, 5834 // FIXME: Are these flags correct? 5835 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5836 AllowedExplicit::Conversions, 5837 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5838 /*CStyle=*/false, 5839 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 5840 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/true); 5841 5842 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'. 5843 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 5844 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 5845 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion: 5846 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion: 5847 break; 5848 5849 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion: 5850 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After); 5851 break; 5852 5853 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 5854 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard); 5855 break; 5856 } 5857 5858 return ICS; 5859 } 5860 5861 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual 5862 /// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type. 5863 /// Returns a valid but null ExprResult if no conversion sequence exists. 5864 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) { 5865 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 5866 return ExprError(); 5867 5868 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType(); 5869 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5870 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From); 5871 if (!ICS.isBad()) 5872 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting); 5873 return ExprResult(); 5874 } 5875 5876 /// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration 5877 /// type of a permitted flavor. 5878 bool Sema::ICEConvertDiagnoser::match(QualType T) { 5879 return AllowScopedEnumerations ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() 5880 : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType(); 5881 } 5882 5883 static ExprResult 5884 diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, 5885 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5886 QualType T, UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions) { 5887 5888 if (Converter.Suppress) 5889 return ExprError(); 5890 5891 Converter.diagnoseAmbiguous(SemaRef, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 5892 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) { 5893 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = 5894 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5895 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5896 Converter.noteAmbiguous(SemaRef, Conv, ConvTy); 5897 } 5898 return From; 5899 } 5900 5901 static bool 5902 diagnoseNoViableConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From, 5903 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5904 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 5905 UnresolvedSetImpl &ExplicitConversions) { 5906 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Converter.Suppress) { 5907 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0]; 5908 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 5909 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5910 5911 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit 5912 // conversion; use it. 5913 QualType ConvTy = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5914 std::string TypeStr; 5915 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, SemaRef.getPrintingPolicy()); 5916 5917 Converter.diagnoseExplicitConv(SemaRef, Loc, T, ConvTy) 5918 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getBeginLoc(), 5919 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(") 5920 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion( 5921 SemaRef.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getEndLoc()), ")"); 5922 Converter.noteExplicitConv(SemaRef, Conversion, ConvTy); 5923 5924 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the 5925 // explicit conversion function. 5926 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext()) 5927 return true; 5928 5929 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found); 5930 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion, 5931 HadMultipleCandidates); 5932 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5933 return true; 5934 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 5935 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(), 5936 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(), 5937 nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind(), 5938 SemaRef.CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 5939 } 5940 return false; 5941 } 5942 5943 static bool recordConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From, 5944 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5945 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 5946 DeclAccessPair &Found) { 5947 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 5948 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5949 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found); 5950 5951 QualType ToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5952 if (!Converter.SuppressConversion) { 5953 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext()) 5954 return true; 5955 5956 Converter.diagnoseConversion(SemaRef, Loc, T, ToType) 5957 << From->getSourceRange(); 5958 } 5959 5960 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion, 5961 HadMultipleCandidates); 5962 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5963 return true; 5964 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 5965 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(), 5966 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(), 5967 nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind(), 5968 SemaRef.CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 5969 return false; 5970 } 5971 5972 static ExprResult finishContextualImplicitConversion( 5973 Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, 5974 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) { 5975 if (!Converter.match(From->getType()) && !Converter.Suppress) 5976 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(SemaRef, Loc, From->getType()) 5977 << From->getSourceRange(); 5978 5979 return SemaRef.DefaultLvalueConversion(From); 5980 } 5981 5982 static void 5983 collectViableConversionCandidates(Sema &SemaRef, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 5984 UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions, 5985 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 5986 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) { 5987 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = ViableConversions[I]; 5988 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 5989 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 5990 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 5991 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 5992 5993 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 5994 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate; 5995 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))) 5996 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 5997 else 5998 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 5999 6000 if (ConvTemplate) 6001 SemaRef.AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 6002 ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, CandidateSet, 6003 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, /*AllowExplicit*/ true); 6004 else 6005 SemaRef.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, 6006 ToType, CandidateSet, 6007 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, 6008 /*AllowExplicit*/ true); 6009 } 6010 } 6011 6012 /// Attempt to convert the given expression to a type which is accepted 6013 /// by the given converter. 6014 /// 6015 /// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to a 6016 /// type accepted by the specified converter. In C++11 and before, the class 6017 /// must have a single non-explicit conversion function converting to a matching 6018 /// type. In C++1y, there can be multiple such conversion functions, but only 6019 /// one target type. 6020 /// 6021 /// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the 6022 /// conversion. 6023 /// 6024 /// \param From The expression we're converting from. 6025 /// 6026 /// \param Converter Used to control and diagnose the conversion process. 6027 /// 6028 /// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if 6029 /// successful. 6030 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextualImplicitConversion( 6031 SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) { 6032 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions. 6033 if (From->isTypeDependent()) 6034 return From; 6035 6036 // Process placeholders immediately. 6037 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) { 6038 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From); 6039 if (result.isInvalid()) 6040 return result; 6041 From = result.get(); 6042 } 6043 6044 // If the expression already has a matching type, we're golden. 6045 QualType T = From->getType(); 6046 if (Converter.match(T)) 6047 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From); 6048 6049 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type? 6050 6051 // We can only perform contextual implicit conversions on objects of class 6052 // type. 6053 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 6054 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6055 if (!Converter.Suppress) 6056 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 6057 return From; 6058 } 6059 6060 // We must have a complete class type. 6061 struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser { 6062 ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter; 6063 Expr *From; 6064 6065 TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, Expr *From) 6066 : Converter(Converter), From(From) {} 6067 6068 void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 6069 Converter.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 6070 } 6071 } IncompleteDiagnoser(Converter, From); 6072 6073 if (Converter.Suppress ? !isCompleteType(Loc, T) 6074 : RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser)) 6075 return From; 6076 6077 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type. 6078 UnresolvedSet<4> 6079 ViableConversions; // These are *potentially* viable in C++1y. 6080 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions; 6081 const auto &Conversions = 6082 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 6083 6084 bool HadMultipleCandidates = 6085 (std::distance(Conversions.begin(), Conversions.end()) > 1); 6086 6087 // To check that there is only one target type, in C++1y: 6088 QualType ToType; 6089 bool HasUniqueTargetType = true; 6090 6091 // Collect explicit or viable (potentially in C++1y) conversions. 6092 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 6093 NamedDecl *D = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 6094 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion; 6095 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 6096 if (ConvTemplate) { 6097 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) 6098 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 6099 else 6100 continue; // C++11 does not consider conversion operator templates(?). 6101 } else 6102 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 6103 6104 assert((!ConvTemplate || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) && 6105 "Conversion operator templates are considered potentially " 6106 "viable in C++1y"); 6107 6108 QualType CurToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 6109 if (Converter.match(CurToType) || ConvTemplate) { 6110 6111 if (Conversion->isExplicit()) { 6112 // FIXME: For C++1y, do we need this restriction? 6113 // cf. diagnoseNoViableConversion() 6114 if (!ConvTemplate) 6115 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 6116 } else { 6117 if (!ConvTemplate && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 6118 if (ToType.isNull()) 6119 ToType = CurToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 6120 else if (HasUniqueTargetType && 6121 (CurToType.getUnqualifiedType() != ToType)) 6122 HasUniqueTargetType = false; 6123 } 6124 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 6125 } 6126 } 6127 } 6128 6129 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 6130 // C++1y [conv]p6: 6131 // ... An expression e of class type E appearing in such a context 6132 // is said to be contextually implicitly converted to a specified 6133 // type T and is well-formed if and only if e can be implicitly 6134 // converted to a type T that is determined as follows: E is searched 6135 // for conversion functions whose return type is cv T or reference to 6136 // cv T such that T is allowed by the context. There shall be 6137 // exactly one such T. 6138 6139 // If no unique T is found: 6140 if (ToType.isNull()) { 6141 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6142 HadMultipleCandidates, 6143 ExplicitConversions)) 6144 return ExprError(); 6145 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter); 6146 } 6147 6148 // If more than one unique Ts are found: 6149 if (!HasUniqueTargetType) 6150 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6151 ViableConversions); 6152 6153 // If one unique T is found: 6154 // First, build a candidate set from the previously recorded 6155 // potentially viable conversions. 6156 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 6157 collectViableConversionCandidates(*this, From, ToType, ViableConversions, 6158 CandidateSet); 6159 6160 // Then, perform overload resolution over the candidate set. 6161 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 6162 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Loc, Best)) { 6163 case OR_Success: { 6164 // Apply this conversion. 6165 DeclAccessPair Found = 6166 DeclAccessPair::make(Best->Function, Best->FoundDecl.getAccess()); 6167 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6168 HadMultipleCandidates, Found)) 6169 return ExprError(); 6170 break; 6171 } 6172 case OR_Ambiguous: 6173 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6174 ViableConversions); 6175 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 6176 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6177 HadMultipleCandidates, 6178 ExplicitConversions)) 6179 return ExprError(); 6180 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 6181 case OR_Deleted: 6182 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type. 6183 break; 6184 } 6185 } else { 6186 switch (ViableConversions.size()) { 6187 case 0: { 6188 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6189 HadMultipleCandidates, 6190 ExplicitConversions)) 6191 return ExprError(); 6192 6193 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type. 6194 break; 6195 } 6196 case 1: { 6197 // Apply this conversion. 6198 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0]; 6199 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6200 HadMultipleCandidates, Found)) 6201 return ExprError(); 6202 break; 6203 } 6204 default: 6205 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 6206 ViableConversions); 6207 } 6208 } 6209 6210 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter); 6211 } 6212 6213 /// IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate - Determine whether Fn is 6214 /// an acceptable non-member overloaded operator for a call whose 6215 /// arguments have types T1 (and, if non-empty, T2). This routine 6216 /// implements the check in C++ [over.match.oper]p3b2 concerning 6217 /// enumeration types. 6218 static bool IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(ASTContext &Context, 6219 FunctionDecl *Fn, 6220 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 6221 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType(); 6222 QualType T2 = Args.size() > 1 ? Args[1]->getType() : QualType(); 6223 6224 if (T1->isDependentType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isDependentType())) 6225 return true; 6226 6227 if (T1->isRecordType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isRecordType())) 6228 return true; 6229 6230 const auto *Proto = Fn->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 6231 if (Proto->getNumParams() < 1) 6232 return false; 6233 6234 if (T1->isEnumeralType()) { 6235 QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(0).getNonReferenceType(); 6236 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, ArgType)) 6237 return true; 6238 } 6239 6240 if (Proto->getNumParams() < 2) 6241 return false; 6242 6243 if (!T2.isNull() && T2->isEnumeralType()) { 6244 QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(1).getNonReferenceType(); 6245 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T2, ArgType)) 6246 return true; 6247 } 6248 6249 return false; 6250 } 6251 6252 /// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of 6253 /// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If 6254 /// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined 6255 /// conversions via constructors or conversion operators. 6256 /// 6257 /// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading 6258 /// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by 6259 /// code completion. 6260 void Sema::AddOverloadCandidate( 6261 FunctionDecl *Function, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6262 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions, 6263 bool PartialOverloading, bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowExplicitConversions, 6264 ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate, ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions, 6265 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 6266 const FunctionProtoType *Proto 6267 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 6268 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 6269 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 6270 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates"); 6271 6272 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) { 6273 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) { 6274 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function 6275 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g., 6276 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created 6277 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member 6278 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied 6279 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context 6280 // is irrelevant. 6281 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(), QualType(), 6282 Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(), Args, 6283 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 6284 PartialOverloading, EarlyConversions, PO); 6285 return; 6286 } 6287 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object 6288 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution. 6289 } 6290 6291 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function, PO)) 6292 return; 6293 6294 // C++11 [class.copy]p11: [DR1402] 6295 // A defaulted move constructor that is defined as deleted is ignored by 6296 // overload resolution. 6297 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function); 6298 if (Constructor && Constructor->isDefaulted() && Constructor->isDeleted() && 6299 Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) 6300 return; 6301 6302 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 6303 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 6304 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 6305 6306 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 6307 // if no operand has a class type, only those non-member functions in the 6308 // lookup set that have a first parameter of type T1 or "reference to 6309 // (possibly cv-qualified) T1", when T1 is an enumeration type, or (if there 6310 // is a right operand) a second parameter of type T2 or "reference to 6311 // (possibly cv-qualified) T2", when T2 is an enumeration type, are 6312 // candidate functions. 6313 if (CandidateSet.getKind() == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator && 6314 !IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(Context, Function, Args)) 6315 return; 6316 6317 // Add this candidate 6318 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 6319 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size(), EarlyConversions); 6320 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6321 Candidate.Function = Function; 6322 Candidate.Viable = true; 6323 Candidate.RewriteKind = 6324 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Function, PO); 6325 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6326 Candidate.IsADLCandidate = IsADLCandidate; 6327 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6328 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6329 6330 // Explicit functions are not actually candidates at all if we're not 6331 // allowing them in this context, but keep them around so we can point 6332 // to them in diagnostics. 6333 if (!AllowExplicit && ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(Function).isExplicit()) { 6334 Candidate.Viable = false; 6335 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit; 6336 return; 6337 } 6338 6339 if (Function->isMultiVersion() && Function->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() && 6340 !Function->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) { 6341 Candidate.Viable = false; 6342 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function; 6343 return; 6344 } 6345 6346 if (Constructor) { 6347 // C++ [class.copy]p3: 6348 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy 6349 // of a class object to an object of its class type. 6350 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent()); 6351 if (Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() && 6352 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) || 6353 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getBeginLoc(), Args[0]->getType(), 6354 ClassType))) { 6355 Candidate.Viable = false; 6356 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_illegal_constructor; 6357 return; 6358 } 6359 6360 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p8: (proposed DR resolution) 6361 // A constructor inherited from class type C that has a first parameter 6362 // of type "reference to P" (including such a constructor instantiated 6363 // from a template) is excluded from the set of candidate functions when 6364 // constructing an object of type cv D if the argument list has exactly 6365 // one argument and D is reference-related to P and P is reference-related 6366 // to C. 6367 auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl.getDecl()); 6368 if (Shadow && Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->getNumParams() >= 1 && 6369 Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isReferenceType()) { 6370 QualType P = Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getPointeeType(); 6371 QualType C = Context.getRecordType(Constructor->getParent()); 6372 QualType D = Context.getRecordType(Shadow->getParent()); 6373 SourceLocation Loc = Args.front()->getExprLoc(); 6374 if ((Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(P, C) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, P, C)) && 6375 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(D, P) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, D, P))) { 6376 Candidate.Viable = false; 6377 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_inhctor_slice; 6378 return; 6379 } 6380 } 6381 6382 // Check that the constructor is capable of constructing an object in the 6383 // destination address space. 6384 if (!Qualifiers::isAddressSpaceSupersetOf( 6385 Constructor->getMethodQualifiers().getAddressSpace(), 6386 CandidateSet.getDestAS())) { 6387 Candidate.Viable = false; 6388 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_object_addrspace_mismatch; 6389 } 6390 } 6391 6392 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 6393 6394 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 6395 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 6396 // list (8.3.5). 6397 if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) && 6398 !Proto->isVariadic()) { 6399 Candidate.Viable = false; 6400 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 6401 return; 6402 } 6403 6404 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 6405 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 6406 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 6407 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 6408 // exactly m parameters. 6409 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments(); 6410 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) { 6411 // Not enough arguments. 6412 Candidate.Viable = false; 6413 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 6414 return; 6415 } 6416 6417 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets. 6418 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 6419 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) 6420 // Skip the check for callers that are implicit members, because in this 6421 // case we may not yet know what the member's target is; the target is 6422 // inferred for the member automatically, based on the bases and fields of 6423 // the class. 6424 if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Function)) { 6425 Candidate.Viable = false; 6426 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target; 6427 return; 6428 } 6429 6430 if (Function->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 6431 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 6432 if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Function, Satisfaction) || 6433 !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) { 6434 Candidate.Viable = false; 6435 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied; 6436 return; 6437 } 6438 } 6439 6440 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 6441 // arguments. 6442 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 6443 unsigned ConvIdx = 6444 PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 - ArgIdx : ArgIdx; 6445 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) { 6446 // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during 6447 // template argument deduction. 6448 } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 6449 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 6450 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 6451 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 6452 // parameter of F. 6453 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 6454 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryCopyInitialization( 6455 *this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, SuppressUserConversions, 6456 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6457 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6458 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, AllowExplicitConversions); 6459 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 6460 Candidate.Viable = false; 6461 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6462 return; 6463 } 6464 } else { 6465 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 6466 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 6467 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 6468 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis(); 6469 } 6470 } 6471 6472 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = 6473 CheckEnableIf(Function, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Args)) { 6474 Candidate.Viable = false; 6475 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 6476 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 6477 return; 6478 } 6479 6480 if (LangOpts.OpenCL && isOpenCLDisabledDecl(Function)) { 6481 Candidate.Viable = false; 6482 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_ext_disabled; 6483 return; 6484 } 6485 } 6486 6487 ObjCMethodDecl * 6488 Sema::SelectBestMethod(Selector Sel, MultiExprArg Args, bool IsInstance, 6489 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCMethodDecl *> &Methods) { 6490 if (Methods.size() <= 1) 6491 return nullptr; 6492 6493 for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) { 6494 bool Match = true; 6495 ObjCMethodDecl *Method = Methods[b]; 6496 unsigned NumNamedArgs = Sel.getNumArgs(); 6497 // Method might have more arguments than selector indicates. This is due 6498 // to addition of c-style arguments in method. 6499 if (Method->param_size() > NumNamedArgs) 6500 NumNamedArgs = Method->param_size(); 6501 if (Args.size() < NumNamedArgs) 6502 continue; 6503 6504 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumNamedArgs; i++) { 6505 // We can't do any type-checking on a type-dependent argument. 6506 if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) { 6507 Match = false; 6508 break; 6509 } 6510 6511 ParmVarDecl *param = Method->parameters()[i]; 6512 Expr *argExpr = Args[i]; 6513 assert(argExpr && "SelectBestMethod(): missing expression"); 6514 6515 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off unless it's 6516 // a consumed argument. 6517 if (argExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast) && 6518 !param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>()) 6519 argExpr = stripARCUnbridgedCast(argExpr); 6520 6521 // If the parameter is __unknown_anytype, move on to the next method. 6522 if (param->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 6523 Match = false; 6524 break; 6525 } 6526 6527 ImplicitConversionSequence ConversionState 6528 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, argExpr, param->getType(), 6529 /*SuppressUserConversions*/false, 6530 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6531 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6532 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, 6533 /*AllowExplicit*/false); 6534 // This function looks for a reasonably-exact match, so we consider 6535 // incompatible pointer conversions to be a failure here. 6536 if (ConversionState.isBad() || 6537 (ConversionState.isStandard() && 6538 ConversionState.Standard.Second == 6539 ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion)) { 6540 Match = false; 6541 break; 6542 } 6543 } 6544 // Promote additional arguments to variadic methods. 6545 if (Match && Method->isVariadic()) { 6546 for (unsigned i = NumNamedArgs, e = Args.size(); i < e; ++i) { 6547 if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) { 6548 Match = false; 6549 break; 6550 } 6551 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 6552 nullptr); 6553 if (Arg.isInvalid()) { 6554 Match = false; 6555 break; 6556 } 6557 } 6558 } else { 6559 // Check for extra arguments to non-variadic methods. 6560 if (Args.size() != NumNamedArgs) 6561 Match = false; 6562 else if (Match && NumNamedArgs == 0 && Methods.size() > 1) { 6563 // Special case when selectors have no argument. In this case, select 6564 // one with the most general result type of 'id'. 6565 for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) { 6566 QualType ReturnT = Methods[b]->getReturnType(); 6567 if (ReturnT->isObjCIdType()) 6568 return Methods[b]; 6569 } 6570 } 6571 } 6572 6573 if (Match) 6574 return Method; 6575 } 6576 return nullptr; 6577 } 6578 6579 static bool convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks( 6580 Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function, Expr *ThisArg, SourceLocation CallLoc, 6581 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, Sema::SFINAETrap &Trap, bool MissingImplicitThis, 6582 Expr *&ConvertedThis, SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &ConvertedArgs) { 6583 if (ThisArg) { 6584 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function); 6585 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) && 6586 "Shouldn't have `this` for ctors!"); 6587 assert(!Method->isStatic() && "Shouldn't have `this` for static methods!"); 6588 ExprResult R = S.PerformObjectArgumentInitialization( 6589 ThisArg, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, Method, Method); 6590 if (R.isInvalid()) 6591 return false; 6592 ConvertedThis = R.get(); 6593 } else { 6594 if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) { 6595 (void)MD; 6596 assert((MissingImplicitThis || MD->isStatic() || 6597 isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD)) && 6598 "Expected `this` for non-ctor instance methods"); 6599 } 6600 ConvertedThis = nullptr; 6601 } 6602 6603 // Ignore any variadic arguments. Converting them is pointless, since the 6604 // user can't refer to them in the function condition. 6605 unsigned ArgSizeNoVarargs = std::min(Function->param_size(), Args.size()); 6606 6607 // Convert the arguments. 6608 for (unsigned I = 0; I != ArgSizeNoVarargs; ++I) { 6609 ExprResult R; 6610 R = S.PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 6611 S.Context, Function->getParamDecl(I)), 6612 SourceLocation(), Args[I]); 6613 6614 if (R.isInvalid()) 6615 return false; 6616 6617 ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get()); 6618 } 6619 6620 if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 6621 return false; 6622 6623 // Push default arguments if needed. 6624 if (!Function->isVariadic() && Args.size() < Function->getNumParams()) { 6625 for (unsigned i = Args.size(), e = Function->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 6626 ParmVarDecl *P = Function->getParamDecl(i); 6627 if (!P->hasDefaultArg()) 6628 return false; 6629 ExprResult R = S.BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, Function, P); 6630 if (R.isInvalid()) 6631 return false; 6632 ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get()); 6633 } 6634 6635 if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 6636 return false; 6637 } 6638 return true; 6639 } 6640 6641 EnableIfAttr *Sema::CheckEnableIf(FunctionDecl *Function, 6642 SourceLocation CallLoc, 6643 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6644 bool MissingImplicitThis) { 6645 auto EnableIfAttrs = Function->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>(); 6646 if (EnableIfAttrs.begin() == EnableIfAttrs.end()) 6647 return nullptr; 6648 6649 SFINAETrap Trap(*this); 6650 SmallVector<Expr *, 16> ConvertedArgs; 6651 // FIXME: We should look into making enable_if late-parsed. 6652 Expr *DiscardedThis; 6653 if (!convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks( 6654 *this, Function, /*ThisArg=*/nullptr, CallLoc, Args, Trap, 6655 /*MissingImplicitThis=*/true, DiscardedThis, ConvertedArgs)) 6656 return *EnableIfAttrs.begin(); 6657 6658 for (auto *EIA : EnableIfAttrs) { 6659 APValue Result; 6660 // FIXME: This doesn't consider value-dependent cases, because doing so is 6661 // very difficult. Ideally, we should handle them more gracefully. 6662 if (EIA->getCond()->isValueDependent() || 6663 !EIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution( 6664 Result, Context, Function, llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvertedArgs))) 6665 return EIA; 6666 6667 if (!Result.isInt() || !Result.getInt().getBoolValue()) 6668 return EIA; 6669 } 6670 return nullptr; 6671 } 6672 6673 template <typename CheckFn> 6674 static bool diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(Sema &S, const NamedDecl *ND, 6675 bool ArgDependent, SourceLocation Loc, 6676 CheckFn &&IsSuccessful) { 6677 SmallVector<const DiagnoseIfAttr *, 8> Attrs; 6678 for (const auto *DIA : ND->specific_attrs<DiagnoseIfAttr>()) { 6679 if (ArgDependent == DIA->getArgDependent()) 6680 Attrs.push_back(DIA); 6681 } 6682 6683 // Common case: No diagnose_if attributes, so we can quit early. 6684 if (Attrs.empty()) 6685 return false; 6686 6687 auto WarningBegin = std::stable_partition( 6688 Attrs.begin(), Attrs.end(), 6689 [](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { return DIA->isError(); }); 6690 6691 // Note that diagnose_if attributes are late-parsed, so they appear in the 6692 // correct order (unlike enable_if attributes). 6693 auto ErrAttr = llvm::find_if(llvm::make_range(Attrs.begin(), WarningBegin), 6694 IsSuccessful); 6695 if (ErrAttr != WarningBegin) { 6696 const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA = *ErrAttr; 6697 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage(); 6698 S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if) 6699 << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange(); 6700 return true; 6701 } 6702 6703 for (const auto *DIA : llvm::make_range(WarningBegin, Attrs.end())) 6704 if (IsSuccessful(DIA)) { 6705 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage(); 6706 S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if) 6707 << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange(); 6708 } 6709 6710 return false; 6711 } 6712 6713 bool Sema::diagnoseArgDependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const FunctionDecl *Function, 6714 const Expr *ThisArg, 6715 ArrayRef<const Expr *> Args, 6716 SourceLocation Loc) { 6717 return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith( 6718 *this, Function, /*ArgDependent=*/true, Loc, 6719 [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { 6720 APValue Result; 6721 // It's sane to use the same Args for any redecl of this function, since 6722 // EvaluateWithSubstitution only cares about the position of each 6723 // argument in the arg list, not the ParmVarDecl* it maps to. 6724 if (!DIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution( 6725 Result, Context, cast<FunctionDecl>(DIA->getParent()), Args, ThisArg)) 6726 return false; 6727 return Result.isInt() && Result.getInt().getBoolValue(); 6728 }); 6729 } 6730 6731 bool Sema::diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const NamedDecl *ND, 6732 SourceLocation Loc) { 6733 return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith( 6734 *this, ND, /*ArgDependent=*/false, Loc, 6735 [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { 6736 bool Result; 6737 return DIA->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Result, Context) && 6738 Result; 6739 }); 6740 } 6741 6742 /// Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to 6743 /// the overload candidate set. 6744 void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 6745 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6746 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6747 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 6748 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6749 bool PartialOverloading, 6750 bool FirstArgumentIsBase) { 6751 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) { 6752 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 6753 ArrayRef<Expr *> FunctionArgs = Args; 6754 6755 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 6756 FunctionDecl *FD = 6757 FunTmpl ? FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl() : cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 6758 6759 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()) { 6760 QualType ObjectType; 6761 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification; 6762 if (Args.size() > 0) { 6763 if (Expr *E = Args[0]) { 6764 // Use the explicit base to restrict the lookup: 6765 ObjectType = E->getType(); 6766 // Pointers in the object arguments are implicitly dereferenced, so we 6767 // always classify them as l-values. 6768 if (!ObjectType.isNull() && ObjectType->isPointerType()) 6769 ObjectClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(); 6770 else 6771 ObjectClassification = E->Classify(Context); 6772 } // .. else there is an implicit base. 6773 FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1); 6774 } 6775 if (FunTmpl) { 6776 AddMethodTemplateCandidate( 6777 FunTmpl, F.getPair(), 6778 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()), 6779 ExplicitTemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 6780 FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 6781 PartialOverloading); 6782 } else { 6783 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(), 6784 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(), ObjectType, 6785 ObjectClassification, FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, 6786 SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading); 6787 } 6788 } else { 6789 // This branch handles both standalone functions and static methods. 6790 6791 // Slice the first argument (which is the base) when we access 6792 // static method as non-static. 6793 if (Args.size() > 0 && 6794 (!Args[0] || (FirstArgumentIsBase && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && 6795 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)))) { 6796 assert(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()); 6797 FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1); 6798 } 6799 if (FunTmpl) { 6800 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), 6801 ExplicitTemplateArgs, FunctionArgs, 6802 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 6803 PartialOverloading); 6804 } else { 6805 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, 6806 SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading); 6807 } 6808 } 6809 } 6810 } 6811 6812 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of 6813 /// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set. 6814 void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, QualType ObjectType, 6815 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 6816 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6817 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6818 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6819 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 6820 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 6821 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext()); 6822 6823 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)) 6824 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl(); 6825 6826 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) { 6827 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) && 6828 "Expected a member function template"); 6829 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext, 6830 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, ObjectType, 6831 ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 6832 SuppressUserConversions, false, PO); 6833 } else { 6834 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext, 6835 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 6836 SuppressUserConversions, false, None, PO); 6837 } 6838 } 6839 6840 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set 6841 /// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments 6842 /// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call 6843 /// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain 6844 /// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't 6845 /// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion 6846 /// operators. 6847 void 6848 Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6849 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType, 6850 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 6851 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6852 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6853 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6854 bool PartialOverloading, 6855 ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions, 6856 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 6857 const FunctionProtoType *Proto 6858 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 6859 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 6860 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) && 6861 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors"); 6862 6863 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method, PO)) 6864 return; 6865 6866 // C++11 [class.copy]p23: [DR1402] 6867 // A defaulted move assignment operator that is defined as deleted is 6868 // ignored by overload resolution. 6869 if (Method->isDefaulted() && Method->isDeleted() && 6870 Method->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) 6871 return; 6872 6873 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 6874 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 6875 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 6876 6877 // Add this candidate 6878 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 6879 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1, EarlyConversions); 6880 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6881 Candidate.Function = Method; 6882 Candidate.RewriteKind = 6883 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Method, PO); 6884 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6885 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6886 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6887 6888 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 6889 6890 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 6891 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 6892 // list (8.3.5). 6893 if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) && 6894 !Proto->isVariadic()) { 6895 Candidate.Viable = false; 6896 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 6897 return; 6898 } 6899 6900 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 6901 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 6902 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 6903 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 6904 // exactly m parameters. 6905 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments(); 6906 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) { 6907 // Not enough arguments. 6908 Candidate.Viable = false; 6909 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 6910 return; 6911 } 6912 6913 Candidate.Viable = true; 6914 6915 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull()) 6916 // The implicit object argument is ignored. 6917 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true; 6918 else { 6919 unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 : 0; 6920 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object 6921 // parameter. 6922 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 6923 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 6924 Method, ActingContext); 6925 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 6926 Candidate.Viable = false; 6927 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6928 return; 6929 } 6930 } 6931 6932 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets. 6933 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 6934 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) 6935 if (!IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Method)) { 6936 Candidate.Viable = false; 6937 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target; 6938 return; 6939 } 6940 6941 if (Method->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 6942 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 6943 if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Method, Satisfaction) || 6944 !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) { 6945 Candidate.Viable = false; 6946 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied; 6947 return; 6948 } 6949 } 6950 6951 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 6952 // arguments. 6953 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 6954 unsigned ConvIdx = 6955 PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 0 : (ArgIdx + 1); 6956 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) { 6957 // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during 6958 // template argument deduction. 6959 } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 6960 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 6961 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 6962 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 6963 // parameter of F. 6964 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 6965 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] 6966 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 6967 SuppressUserConversions, 6968 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6969 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6970 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 6971 if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 6972 Candidate.Viable = false; 6973 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6974 return; 6975 } 6976 } else { 6977 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 6978 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 6979 // considered to "match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 6980 Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis(); 6981 } 6982 } 6983 6984 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = 6985 CheckEnableIf(Method, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Args, true)) { 6986 Candidate.Viable = false; 6987 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 6988 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 6989 return; 6990 } 6991 6992 if (Method->isMultiVersion() && Method->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() && 6993 !Method->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) { 6994 Candidate.Viable = false; 6995 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function; 6996 } 6997 } 6998 6999 /// Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate 7000 /// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member 7001 /// function template specialization. 7002 void Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate( 7003 FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7004 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 7005 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, QualType ObjectType, 7006 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7007 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions, 7008 bool PartialOverloading, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 7009 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl, PO)) 7010 return; 7011 7012 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 7013 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 7014 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 7015 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 7016 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 7017 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 7018 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 7019 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 7020 // functions. 7021 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 7022 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 7023 ConversionSequenceList Conversions; 7024 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments( 7025 MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info, 7026 PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) { 7027 return CheckNonDependentConversions( 7028 MethodTmpl, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, Conversions, 7029 SuppressUserConversions, ActingContext, ObjectType, 7030 ObjectClassification, PO); 7031 })) { 7032 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 7033 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions); 7034 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7035 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(); 7036 Candidate.Viable = false; 7037 Candidate.RewriteKind = 7038 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Candidate.Function, PO); 7039 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7040 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = 7041 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function)->isStatic() || 7042 ObjectType.isNull(); 7043 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 7044 if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure) 7045 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7046 else { 7047 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 7048 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 7049 Info); 7050 } 7051 return; 7052 } 7053 7054 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 7055 // deduction as a candidate. 7056 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?"); 7057 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) && 7058 "Specialization is not a member function?"); 7059 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl, 7060 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, 7061 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading, 7062 Conversions, PO); 7063 } 7064 7065 /// Determine whether a given function template has a simple explicit specifier 7066 /// or a non-value-dependent explicit-specification that evaluates to true. 7067 static bool isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD) { 7068 return ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(FTD->getTemplatedDecl()).isExplicit(); 7069 } 7070 7071 /// Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate 7072 /// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce 7073 /// an appropriate function template specialization. 7074 void Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 7075 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7076 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7077 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions, 7078 bool PartialOverloading, bool AllowExplicit, ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate, 7079 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 7080 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate, PO)) 7081 return; 7082 7083 // If the function template has a non-dependent explicit specification, 7084 // exclude it now if appropriate; we are not permitted to perform deduction 7085 // and substitution in this case. 7086 if (!AllowExplicit && isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplate)) { 7087 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 7088 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7089 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7090 Candidate.Viable = false; 7091 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit; 7092 return; 7093 } 7094 7095 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 7096 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 7097 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 7098 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 7099 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 7100 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 7101 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 7102 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 7103 // functions. 7104 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 7105 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 7106 ConversionSequenceList Conversions; 7107 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments( 7108 FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info, 7109 PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) { 7110 return CheckNonDependentConversions( 7111 FunctionTemplate, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, Conversions, 7112 SuppressUserConversions, nullptr, QualType(), {}, PO); 7113 })) { 7114 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 7115 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions); 7116 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7117 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7118 Candidate.Viable = false; 7119 Candidate.RewriteKind = 7120 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Candidate.Function, PO); 7121 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7122 Candidate.IsADLCandidate = IsADLCandidate; 7123 // Ignore the object argument if there is one, since we don't have an object 7124 // type. 7125 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = 7126 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function) && 7127 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Candidate.Function); 7128 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 7129 if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure) 7130 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7131 else { 7132 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 7133 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 7134 Info); 7135 } 7136 return; 7137 } 7138 7139 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 7140 // deduction as a candidate. 7141 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 7142 AddOverloadCandidate( 7143 Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 7144 PartialOverloading, AllowExplicit, 7145 /*AllowExplicitConversions*/ false, IsADLCandidate, Conversions, PO); 7146 } 7147 7148 /// Check that implicit conversion sequences can be formed for each argument 7149 /// whose corresponding parameter has a non-dependent type, per DR1391's 7150 /// [temp.deduct.call]p10. 7151 bool Sema::CheckNonDependentConversions( 7152 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes, 7153 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 7154 ConversionSequenceList &Conversions, bool SuppressUserConversions, 7155 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType, 7156 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 7157 // FIXME: The cases in which we allow explicit conversions for constructor 7158 // arguments never consider calling a constructor template. It's not clear 7159 // that is correct. 7160 const bool AllowExplicit = false; 7161 7162 auto *FD = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7163 auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 7164 bool HasThisConversion = Method && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method); 7165 unsigned ThisConversions = HasThisConversion ? 1 : 0; 7166 7167 Conversions = 7168 CandidateSet.allocateConversionSequences(ThisConversions + Args.size()); 7169 7170 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7171 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7172 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7173 7174 // For a method call, check the 'this' conversion here too. DR1391 doesn't 7175 // require that, but this check should never result in a hard error, and 7176 // overload resolution is permitted to sidestep instantiations. 7177 if (HasThisConversion && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic() && 7178 !ObjectType.isNull()) { 7179 unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 : 0; 7180 Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 7181 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 7182 Method, ActingContext); 7183 if (Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) 7184 return true; 7185 } 7186 7187 for (unsigned I = 0, N = std::min(ParamTypes.size(), Args.size()); I != N; 7188 ++I) { 7189 QualType ParamType = ParamTypes[I]; 7190 if (!ParamType->isDependentType()) { 7191 unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed 7192 ? 0 7193 : (ThisConversions + I); 7194 Conversions[ConvIdx] 7195 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[I], ParamType, 7196 SuppressUserConversions, 7197 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 7198 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 7199 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, 7200 AllowExplicit); 7201 if (Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) 7202 return true; 7203 } 7204 } 7205 7206 return false; 7207 } 7208 7209 /// Determine whether this is an allowable conversion from the result 7210 /// of an explicit conversion operator to the expected type, per C++ 7211 /// [over.match.conv]p1 and [over.match.ref]p1. 7212 /// 7213 /// \param ConvType The return type of the conversion function. 7214 /// 7215 /// \param ToType The type we are converting to. 7216 /// 7217 /// \param AllowObjCPointerConversion Allow a conversion from one 7218 /// Objective-C pointer to another. 7219 /// 7220 /// \returns true if the conversion is allowable, false otherwise. 7221 static bool isAllowableExplicitConversion(Sema &S, 7222 QualType ConvType, QualType ToType, 7223 bool AllowObjCPointerConversion) { 7224 QualType ToNonRefType = ToType.getNonReferenceType(); 7225 7226 // Easy case: the types are the same. 7227 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ConvType, ToNonRefType)) 7228 return true; 7229 7230 // Allow qualification conversions. 7231 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion; 7232 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, /*CStyle*/false, 7233 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) 7234 return true; 7235 7236 // If we're not allowed to consider Objective-C pointer conversions, 7237 // we're done. 7238 if (!AllowObjCPointerConversion) 7239 return false; 7240 7241 // Is this an Objective-C pointer conversion? 7242 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 7243 QualType ConvertedType; 7244 return S.isObjCPointerConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, ConvertedType, 7245 IncompatibleObjC); 7246 } 7247 7248 /// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a 7249 /// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv], 7250 /// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from, 7251 /// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to 7252 /// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the 7253 /// conversion function produces). 7254 void Sema::AddConversionCandidate( 7255 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7256 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 7257 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 7258 bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion) { 7259 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 7260 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate"); 7261 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 7262 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 7263 return; 7264 7265 // If the conversion function has an undeduced return type, trigger its 7266 // deduction now. 7267 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && ConvType->isUndeducedType()) { 7268 if (DeduceReturnType(Conversion, From->getExprLoc())) 7269 return; 7270 ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 7271 } 7272 7273 // If we don't allow any conversion of the result type, ignore conversion 7274 // functions that don't convert to exactly (possibly cv-qualified) T. 7275 if (!AllowResultConversion && 7276 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Conversion->getConversionType(), ToType)) 7277 return; 7278 7279 // Per C++ [over.match.conv]p1, [over.match.ref]p1, an explicit conversion 7280 // operator is only a candidate if its return type is the target type or 7281 // can be converted to the target type with a qualification conversion. 7282 // 7283 // FIXME: Include such functions in the candidate list and explain why we 7284 // can't select them. 7285 if (Conversion->isExplicit() && 7286 !isAllowableExplicitConversion(*this, ConvType, ToType, 7287 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) 7288 return; 7289 7290 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7291 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7292 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7293 7294 // Add this candidate 7295 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1); 7296 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7297 Candidate.Function = Conversion; 7298 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7299 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7300 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion(); 7301 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType); 7302 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType); 7303 Candidate.Viable = true; 7304 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1; 7305 7306 // Explicit functions are not actually candidates at all if we're not 7307 // allowing them in this context, but keep them around so we can point 7308 // to them in diagnostics. 7309 if (!AllowExplicit && Conversion->isExplicit()) { 7310 Candidate.Viable = false; 7311 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit; 7312 return; 7313 } 7314 7315 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4: 7316 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of 7317 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of 7318 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter. 7319 // 7320 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 7321 // object parameter. 7322 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType(); 7323 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>()) 7324 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(); 7325 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext 7326 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 7327 7328 Candidate.Conversions[0] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 7329 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), From->getType(), 7330 From->Classify(Context), Conversion, ConversionContext); 7331 7332 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) { 7333 Candidate.Viable = false; 7334 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7335 return; 7336 } 7337 7338 if (Conversion->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 7339 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 7340 if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Conversion, Satisfaction) || 7341 !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) { 7342 Candidate.Viable = false; 7343 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied; 7344 return; 7345 } 7346 } 7347 7348 // We won't go through a user-defined type conversion function to convert a 7349 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only 7350 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user] 7351 QualType FromCanon 7352 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 7353 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 7354 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || 7355 IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), FromCanon, ToCanon)) { 7356 Candidate.Viable = false; 7357 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion; 7358 return; 7359 } 7360 7361 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the 7362 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to 7363 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the 7364 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This 7365 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to 7366 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this 7367 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be 7368 // well-formed. 7369 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Context, Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(), 7370 VK_LValue, From->getBeginLoc()); 7371 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack, 7372 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()), 7373 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, &ConversionRef, 7374 VK_RValue, FPOptionsOverride()); 7375 7376 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType(); 7377 if (!isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ConversionType)) { 7378 Candidate.Viable = false; 7379 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 7380 return; 7381 } 7382 7383 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType); 7384 7385 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because 7386 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's 7387 // allocator). 7388 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 7389 7390 alignas(CallExpr) char Buffer[sizeof(CallExpr) + sizeof(Stmt *)]; 7391 CallExpr *TheTemporaryCall = CallExpr::CreateTemporary( 7392 Buffer, &ConversionFn, CallResultType, VK, From->getBeginLoc()); 7393 7394 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 7395 TryCopyInitialization(*this, TheTemporaryCall, ToType, 7396 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true, 7397 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 7398 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 7399 7400 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 7401 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 7402 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard; 7403 7404 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3: 7405 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a 7406 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence 7407 // shall have exact match rank. 7408 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() && 7409 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) { 7410 Candidate.Viable = false; 7411 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact; 7412 return; 7413 } 7414 7415 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5: 7416 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and 7417 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined 7418 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the 7419 // program is ill-formed. 7420 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() && 7421 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) { 7422 Candidate.Viable = false; 7423 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 7424 return; 7425 } 7426 break; 7427 7428 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 7429 Candidate.Viable = false; 7430 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 7431 return; 7432 7433 default: 7434 llvm_unreachable( 7435 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure"); 7436 } 7437 7438 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = 7439 CheckEnableIf(Conversion, CandidateSet.getLocation(), None)) { 7440 Candidate.Viable = false; 7441 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 7442 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 7443 return; 7444 } 7445 7446 if (Conversion->isMultiVersion() && Conversion->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() && 7447 !Conversion->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) { 7448 Candidate.Viable = false; 7449 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function; 7450 } 7451 } 7452 7453 /// Adds a conversion function template specialization 7454 /// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction 7455 /// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function 7456 /// template from the type that we are converting to (C++ 7457 /// [temp.deduct.conv]). 7458 void Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 7459 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7460 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 7461 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 7462 bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion) { 7463 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) && 7464 "Only conversion function templates permitted here"); 7465 7466 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate)) 7467 return; 7468 7469 // If the function template has a non-dependent explicit specification, 7470 // exclude it now if appropriate; we are not permitted to perform deduction 7471 // and substitution in this case. 7472 if (!AllowExplicit && isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplate)) { 7473 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 7474 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7475 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7476 Candidate.Viable = false; 7477 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit; 7478 return; 7479 } 7480 7481 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 7482 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 7483 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 7484 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType, 7485 Specialization, Info)) { 7486 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 7487 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7488 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7489 Candidate.Viable = false; 7490 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 7491 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7492 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7493 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1; 7494 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 7495 Info); 7496 return; 7497 } 7498 7499 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by 7500 // template argument deduction as a candidate. 7501 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 7502 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType, 7503 CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 7504 AllowExplicit, AllowResultConversion); 7505 } 7506 7507 /// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that 7508 /// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the 7509 /// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it 7510 /// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is 7511 /// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling. 7512 void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, 7513 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7514 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 7515 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 7516 Expr *Object, 7517 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7518 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) { 7519 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 7520 return; 7521 7522 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7523 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7524 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7525 7526 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1); 7527 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7528 Candidate.Function = nullptr; 7529 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion; 7530 Candidate.Viable = true; 7531 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true; 7532 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7533 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 7534 7535 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 7536 // object parameter. 7537 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 7538 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Object->getType(), 7539 Object->Classify(Context), Conversion, ActingContext); 7540 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) { 7541 Candidate.Viable = false; 7542 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7543 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit; 7544 return; 7545 } 7546 7547 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose 7548 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is 7549 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such. 7550 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined(); 7551 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard; 7552 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 7553 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false; 7554 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 7555 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl; 7556 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After 7557 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before; 7558 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 7559 7560 // Find the 7561 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 7562 7563 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 7564 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 7565 // list (8.3.5). 7566 if (Args.size() > NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()) { 7567 Candidate.Viable = false; 7568 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 7569 return; 7570 } 7571 7572 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if 7573 // we have enough arguments. 7574 if (Args.size() < NumParams) { 7575 // Not enough arguments. 7576 Candidate.Viable = false; 7577 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 7578 return; 7579 } 7580 7581 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 7582 // arguments. 7583 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7584 if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 7585 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 7586 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 7587 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 7588 // parameter of F. 7589 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 7590 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1] 7591 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 7592 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 7593 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 7594 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 7595 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 7596 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) { 7597 Candidate.Viable = false; 7598 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7599 return; 7600 } 7601 } else { 7602 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 7603 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 7604 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 7605 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis(); 7606 } 7607 } 7608 7609 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = 7610 CheckEnableIf(Conversion, CandidateSet.getLocation(), None)) { 7611 Candidate.Viable = false; 7612 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 7613 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 7614 return; 7615 } 7616 } 7617 7618 /// Add all of the non-member operator function declarations in the given 7619 /// function set to the overload candidate set. 7620 void Sema::AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates( 7621 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7622 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 7623 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs) { 7624 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) { 7625 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 7626 ArrayRef<Expr *> FunctionArgs = Args; 7627 7628 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 7629 FunctionDecl *FD = 7630 FunTmpl ? FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl() : cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 7631 7632 // Don't consider rewritten functions if we're not rewriting. 7633 if (!CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().isAcceptableCandidate(FD)) 7634 continue; 7635 7636 assert(!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && 7637 "unqualified operator lookup found a member function"); 7638 7639 if (FunTmpl) { 7640 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, 7641 FunctionArgs, CandidateSet); 7642 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD)) 7643 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 7644 FunTmpl, F.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, 7645 {FunctionArgs[1], FunctionArgs[0]}, CandidateSet, false, false, 7646 true, ADLCallKind::NotADL, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 7647 } else { 7648 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) 7649 continue; 7650 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), FunctionArgs, CandidateSet); 7651 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD)) 7652 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), 7653 {FunctionArgs[1], FunctionArgs[0]}, CandidateSet, 7654 false, false, true, false, ADLCallKind::NotADL, 7655 None, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 7656 } 7657 } 7658 } 7659 7660 /// Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are 7661 /// member functions. 7662 /// 7663 /// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions 7664 /// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such 7665 /// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and 7666 /// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++ 7667 /// [over.match.oper]). 7668 void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 7669 SourceLocation OpLoc, 7670 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7671 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 7672 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) { 7673 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 7674 7675 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 7676 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose 7677 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with 7678 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and 7679 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2, 7680 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member 7681 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are 7682 // constructed as follows: 7683 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType(); 7684 7685 // -- If T1 is a complete class type or a class currently being 7686 // defined, the set of member candidates is the result of the 7687 // qualified lookup of T1::operator@ (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, 7688 // the set of member candidates is empty. 7689 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) { 7690 // Complete the type if it can be completed. 7691 if (!isCompleteType(OpLoc, T1) && !T1Rec->isBeingDefined()) 7692 return; 7693 // If the type is neither complete nor being defined, bail out now. 7694 if (!T1Rec->getDecl()->getDefinition()) 7695 return; 7696 7697 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 7698 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl()); 7699 Operators.suppressDiagnostics(); 7700 7701 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(), 7702 OperEnd = Operators.end(); 7703 Oper != OperEnd; 7704 ++Oper) 7705 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(), 7706 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1), 7707 CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false, PO); 7708 } 7709 } 7710 7711 /// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in 7712 /// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types 7713 /// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the 7714 /// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator 7715 /// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment 7716 /// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments 7717 /// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually 7718 /// converted to bool. 7719 void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType *ParamTys, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7720 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 7721 bool IsAssignmentOperator, 7722 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) { 7723 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7724 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7725 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7726 7727 // Add this candidate 7728 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size()); 7729 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_none); 7730 Candidate.Function = nullptr; 7731 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7732 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7733 std::copy(ParamTys, ParamTys + Args.size(), Candidate.BuiltinParamTypes); 7734 7735 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 7736 // arguments. 7737 Candidate.Viable = true; 7738 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 7739 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7740 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4: 7741 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the 7742 // left operand are restricted as follows: 7743 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and 7744 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left 7745 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most 7746 // parameter of a built-in candidate. 7747 // 7748 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined 7749 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of 7750 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that 7751 // is not of the same type. 7752 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) { 7753 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy && 7754 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type"); 7755 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 7756 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]); 7757 } else { 7758 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 7759 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx], 7760 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator, 7761 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 7762 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 7763 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 7764 } 7765 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) { 7766 Candidate.Viable = false; 7767 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7768 break; 7769 } 7770 } 7771 } 7772 7773 namespace { 7774 7775 /// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the 7776 /// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++ 7777 /// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and 7778 /// enumeration types. 7779 class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet { 7780 /// TypeSet - A set of types. 7781 typedef llvm::SetVector<QualType, SmallVector<QualType, 8>, 7782 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8>> TypeSet; 7783 7784 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the 7785 /// built-in candidates. 7786 TypeSet PointerTypes; 7787 7788 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be 7789 /// used in the built-in candidates. 7790 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes; 7791 7792 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be 7793 /// used in the built-in candidates. 7794 TypeSet EnumerationTypes; 7795 7796 /// The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in 7797 /// candidates. 7798 TypeSet VectorTypes; 7799 7800 /// The set of matrix types that will be used in the built-in 7801 /// candidates. 7802 TypeSet MatrixTypes; 7803 7804 /// A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates 7805 bool HasNonRecordTypes; 7806 7807 /// A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types 7808 /// were present in the candidate set. 7809 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; 7810 7811 /// A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the 7812 /// candidate set. 7813 bool HasNullPtrType; 7814 7815 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the 7816 /// candidate type set. 7817 Sema &SemaRef; 7818 7819 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets. 7820 ASTContext &Context; 7821 7822 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 7823 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals); 7824 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty); 7825 7826 public: 7827 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set. 7828 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator; 7829 7830 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef) 7831 : HasNonRecordTypes(false), 7832 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false), 7833 HasNullPtrType(false), 7834 SemaRef(SemaRef), 7835 Context(SemaRef.Context) { } 7836 7837 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 7838 SourceLocation Loc, 7839 bool AllowUserConversions, 7840 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 7841 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 7842 7843 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found; 7844 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); } 7845 7846 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found; 7847 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); } 7848 7849 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found; 7850 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); } 7851 7852 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found; 7853 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); } 7854 7855 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found; 7856 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); } 7857 7858 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found; 7859 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); } 7860 7861 llvm::iterator_range<iterator> vector_types() { return VectorTypes; } 7862 7863 llvm::iterator_range<iterator> matrix_types() { return MatrixTypes; } 7864 7865 bool containsMatrixType(QualType Ty) const { return MatrixTypes.count(Ty); } 7866 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; } 7867 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; } 7868 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; } 7869 }; 7870 7871 } // end anonymous namespace 7872 7873 /// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to 7874 /// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 7875 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 7876 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 7877 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 7878 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 7879 /// false otherwise. 7880 /// 7881 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 7882 bool 7883 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 7884 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 7885 7886 // Insert this type. 7887 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty)) 7888 return false; 7889 7890 QualType PointeeTy; 7891 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>(); 7892 bool buildObjCPtr = false; 7893 if (!PointerTy) { 7894 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 7895 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 7896 buildObjCPtr = true; 7897 } else { 7898 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 7899 } 7900 7901 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 7902 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 7903 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 7904 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 7905 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 7906 return true; 7907 7908 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 7909 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile(); 7910 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict(); 7911 7912 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR. 7913 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 7914 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 7915 // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types. 7916 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue; 7917 7918 // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if 7919 // the type cannot be restrict-qualified. 7920 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && 7921 (!hasRestrict || 7922 (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType())))) 7923 continue; 7924 7925 // Build qualified pointee type. 7926 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 7927 7928 // Build qualified pointer type. 7929 QualType QPointerTy; 7930 if (!buildObjCPtr) 7931 QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy); 7932 else 7933 QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy); 7934 7935 // Insert qualified pointer type. 7936 PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy); 7937 } 7938 7939 return true; 7940 } 7941 7942 /// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty 7943 /// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 7944 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 7945 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 7946 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 7947 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 7948 /// false otherwise. 7949 /// 7950 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 7951 bool 7952 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants( 7953 QualType Ty) { 7954 // Insert this type. 7955 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty)) 7956 return false; 7957 7958 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 7959 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!"); 7960 7961 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 7962 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 7963 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 7964 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 7965 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 7966 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 7967 return true; 7968 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass(); 7969 7970 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR 7971 // qualifiers. 7972 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 7973 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 7974 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 7975 7976 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 7977 MemberPointerTypes.insert( 7978 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy)); 7979 } 7980 7981 return true; 7982 } 7983 7984 /// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p 7985 /// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're 7986 /// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also 7987 /// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator. 7988 /// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion 7989 /// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we 7990 /// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class 7991 /// type. 7992 void 7993 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 7994 SourceLocation Loc, 7995 bool AllowUserConversions, 7996 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 7997 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 7998 // Only deal with canonical types. 7999 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty); 8000 8001 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an 8002 // expression for the purposes of conversions. 8003 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 8004 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType(); 8005 8006 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer. 8007 if (Ty->isArrayType()) 8008 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty); 8009 8010 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type. 8011 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType(); 8012 8013 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type. 8014 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 8015 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec; 8016 8017 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type. 8018 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = 8019 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType(); 8020 8021 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType()) 8022 PointerTypes.insert(Ty); 8023 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 8024 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set 8025 // of types. 8026 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals)) 8027 return; 8028 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 8029 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted. 8030 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty)) 8031 return; 8032 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) { 8033 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 8034 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty); 8035 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) { 8036 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an 8037 // extension. 8038 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 8039 VectorTypes.insert(Ty); 8040 } else if (Ty->isMatrixType()) { 8041 // Similar to vector types, we treat vector types as arithmetic types in 8042 // many contexts as an extension. 8043 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 8044 MatrixTypes.insert(Ty); 8045 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) { 8046 HasNullPtrType = true; 8047 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) { 8048 // No conversion functions in incomplete types. 8049 if (!SemaRef.isCompleteType(Loc, Ty)) 8050 return; 8051 8052 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 8053 for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) { 8054 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 8055 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 8056 8057 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything 8058 // about which builtin types we can convert to. 8059 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 8060 continue; 8061 8062 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 8063 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) { 8064 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false, 8065 VisibleQuals); 8066 } 8067 } 8068 } 8069 } 8070 /// Helper function for adjusting address spaces for the pointer or reference 8071 /// operands of builtin operators depending on the argument. 8072 static QualType AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T, 8073 Expr *Arg) { 8074 return S.Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(T, Arg->getType().getAddressSpace()); 8075 } 8076 8077 /// Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds 8078 /// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the 8079 /// given type to the candidate set. 8080 static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S, 8081 QualType T, 8082 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 8083 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 8084 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8085 8086 // T& operator=(T&, T) 8087 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8088 AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(S, T, Args[0])); 8089 ParamTypes[1] = T; 8090 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8091 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8092 8093 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) { 8094 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T) 8095 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8096 AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(S, S.Context.getVolatileType(T), 8097 Args[0])); 8098 ParamTypes[1] = T; 8099 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8100 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8101 } 8102 } 8103 8104 /// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers, 8105 /// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type. 8106 static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) { 8107 Qualifiers VRQuals; 8108 const RecordType *TyRec; 8109 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType = 8110 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 8111 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>(); 8112 else 8113 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 8114 if (!TyRec) { 8115 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case. 8116 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 8117 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 8118 return VRQuals; 8119 } 8120 8121 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 8122 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition()) 8123 return VRQuals; 8124 8125 for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) { 8126 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 8127 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 8128 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) { 8129 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType()); 8130 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 8131 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 8132 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers 8133 // as see them. 8134 bool done = false; 8135 while (!done) { 8136 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified()) 8137 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 8138 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 8139 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 8140 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr = 8141 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 8142 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType(); 8143 else 8144 done = true; 8145 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified()) 8146 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 8147 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile()) 8148 return VRQuals; 8149 } 8150 } 8151 } 8152 return VRQuals; 8153 } 8154 8155 namespace { 8156 8157 /// Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload 8158 /// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout 8159 /// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin 8160 /// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set. 8161 class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder { 8162 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods. 8163 Sema &S; 8164 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args; 8165 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals; 8166 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType; 8167 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes; 8168 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet; 8169 8170 static constexpr int ArithmeticTypesCap = 24; 8171 SmallVector<CanQualType, ArithmeticTypesCap> ArithmeticTypes; 8172 8173 // Define some indices used to iterate over the arithmetic types in 8174 // ArithmeticTypes. The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic 8175 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2). 8176 unsigned FirstIntegralType, 8177 LastIntegralType; 8178 unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType, 8179 LastPromotedIntegralType; 8180 unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType, 8181 LastPromotedArithmeticType; 8182 unsigned NumArithmeticTypes; 8183 8184 void InitArithmeticTypes() { 8185 // Start of promoted types. 8186 FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0; 8187 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.FloatTy); 8188 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.DoubleTy); 8189 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongDoubleTy); 8190 if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasFloat128Type()) 8191 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Float128Ty); 8192 8193 // Start of integral types. 8194 FirstIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8195 FirstPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8196 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.IntTy); 8197 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongTy); 8198 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongLongTy); 8199 if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type()) 8200 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Int128Ty); 8201 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedIntTy); 8202 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongTy); 8203 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy); 8204 if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type()) 8205 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty); 8206 LastPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8207 LastPromotedArithmeticType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8208 // End of promoted types. 8209 8210 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.BoolTy); 8211 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.CharTy); 8212 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.WCharTy); 8213 if (S.Context.getLangOpts().Char8) 8214 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char8Ty); 8215 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char16Ty); 8216 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char32Ty); 8217 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.SignedCharTy); 8218 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.ShortTy); 8219 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedCharTy); 8220 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedShortTy); 8221 LastIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8222 NumArithmeticTypes = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 8223 // End of integral types. 8224 // FIXME: What about complex? What about half? 8225 8226 assert(ArithmeticTypes.size() <= ArithmeticTypesCap && 8227 "Enough inline storage for all arithmetic types."); 8228 } 8229 8230 /// Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads 8231 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators. 8232 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy, 8233 bool HasVolatile, 8234 bool HasRestrict) { 8235 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 8236 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy), 8237 S.Context.IntTy 8238 }; 8239 8240 // Non-volatile version. 8241 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8242 8243 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set: 8244 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type. 8245 if (HasVolatile) { 8246 ParamTypes[0] = 8247 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8248 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy)); 8249 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8250 } 8251 8252 // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type 8253 // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer. 8254 if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() && 8255 !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) { 8256 ParamTypes[0] 8257 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8258 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict)); 8259 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8260 8261 if (HasVolatile) { 8262 ParamTypes[0] 8263 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8264 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, 8265 (Qualifiers::Volatile | 8266 Qualifiers::Restrict))); 8267 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8268 } 8269 } 8270 8271 } 8272 8273 /// Helper to add an overload candidate for a binary builtin with types \p L 8274 /// and \p R. 8275 void AddCandidate(QualType L, QualType R) { 8276 QualType LandR[2] = {L, R}; 8277 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8278 } 8279 8280 public: 8281 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder( 8282 Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 8283 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals, 8284 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType, 8285 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes, 8286 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) 8287 : S(S), Args(Args), 8288 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals), 8289 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType( 8290 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType), 8291 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes), 8292 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) { 8293 8294 InitArithmeticTypes(); 8295 } 8296 8297 // Increment is deprecated for bool since C++17. 8298 // 8299 // C++ [over.built]p3: 8300 // 8301 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other 8302 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist 8303 // candidate operator functions of the form 8304 // 8305 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&); 8306 // T operator++(VQ T&, int); 8307 // 8308 // C++ [over.built]p4: 8309 // 8310 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other 8311 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist 8312 // candidate operator functions of the form 8313 // 8314 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&); 8315 // T operator--(VQ T&, int); 8316 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 8317 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8318 return; 8319 8320 for (unsigned Arith = 0; Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) { 8321 const auto TypeOfT = ArithmeticTypes[Arith]; 8322 if (TypeOfT == S.Context.BoolTy) { 8323 if (Op == OO_MinusMinus) 8324 continue; 8325 if (Op == OO_PlusPlus && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17) 8326 continue; 8327 } 8328 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads( 8329 TypeOfT, 8330 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(), 8331 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()); 8332 } 8333 } 8334 8335 // C++ [over.built]p5: 8336 // 8337 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 8338 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or 8339 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8340 // 8341 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&); 8342 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&); 8343 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int); 8344 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int); 8345 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() { 8346 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8347 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8348 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8349 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8350 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types. 8351 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType()) 8352 continue; 8353 8354 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr, 8355 (!(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 8356 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()), 8357 (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() && 8358 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict())); 8359 } 8360 } 8361 8362 // C++ [over.built]p6: 8363 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there 8364 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8365 // 8366 // T& operator*(T*); 8367 // 8368 // C++ [over.built]p7: 8369 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a 8370 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8371 // T& operator*(T*); 8372 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() { 8373 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8374 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8375 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8376 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8377 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr; 8378 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType(); 8379 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) 8380 continue; 8381 8382 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 8383 if (Proto->getMethodQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier()) 8384 continue; 8385 8386 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8387 } 8388 } 8389 8390 // C++ [over.built]p9: 8391 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate 8392 // operator functions of the form 8393 // 8394 // T operator+(T); 8395 // T operator-(T); 8396 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() { 8397 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8398 return; 8399 8400 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8401 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) { 8402 QualType ArithTy = ArithmeticTypes[Arith]; 8403 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ArithTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8404 } 8405 8406 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types. 8407 for (QualType VecTy : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) 8408 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8409 } 8410 8411 // C++ [over.built]p8: 8412 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of 8413 // the form 8414 // 8415 // T* operator+(T*); 8416 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() { 8417 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8418 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8419 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8420 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8421 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr; 8422 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8423 } 8424 } 8425 8426 // C++ [over.built]p10: 8427 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate 8428 // operator functions of the form 8429 // 8430 // T operator~(T); 8431 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() { 8432 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8433 return; 8434 8435 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8436 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) { 8437 QualType IntTy = ArithmeticTypes[Int]; 8438 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&IntTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8439 } 8440 8441 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types. 8442 for (QualType VecTy : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) 8443 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet); 8444 } 8445 8446 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16: 8447 // For every pointer to member type T or type std::nullptr_t, there 8448 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8449 // 8450 // bool operator==(T,T); 8451 // bool operator!=(T,T); 8452 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads() { 8453 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8454 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8455 8456 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 8457 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8458 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 8459 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 8460 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; 8461 ++MemPtr) { 8462 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 8463 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second) 8464 continue; 8465 8466 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr }; 8467 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8468 } 8469 8470 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) { 8471 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy); 8472 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy).second) { 8473 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy }; 8474 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8475 } 8476 } 8477 } 8478 } 8479 8480 // C++ [over.built]p15: 8481 // 8482 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type or a pointer type, 8483 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8484 // 8485 // bool operator<(T, T); 8486 // bool operator>(T, T); 8487 // bool operator<=(T, T); 8488 // bool operator>=(T, T); 8489 // bool operator==(T, T); 8490 // bool operator!=(T, T); 8491 // R operator<=>(T, T) 8492 void addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() { 8493 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 8494 // [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator 8495 // functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...] 8496 // do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member 8497 // candidate. 8498 // 8499 // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there 8500 // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator 8501 // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other 8502 // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=, 8503 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place 8504 // where we must suppress candidates like this. 8505 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> > 8506 UserDefinedBinaryOperators; 8507 8508 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 8509 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() != 8510 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) { 8511 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(), 8512 CEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 8513 C != CEnd; ++C) { 8514 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2) 8515 continue; 8516 8517 if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 8518 continue; 8519 8520 // We interpret "same parameter-type-list" as applying to the 8521 // "synthesized candidate, with the order of the two parameters 8522 // reversed", not to the original function. 8523 bool Reversed = C->isReversed(); 8524 QualType FirstParamType = C->Function->getParamDecl(Reversed ? 1 : 0) 8525 ->getType() 8526 .getUnqualifiedType(); 8527 QualType SecondParamType = C->Function->getParamDecl(Reversed ? 0 : 1) 8528 ->getType() 8529 .getUnqualifiedType(); 8530 8531 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type. 8532 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() || 8533 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType()) 8534 continue; 8535 8536 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators. 8537 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert( 8538 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType), 8539 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType))); 8540 } 8541 } 8542 } 8543 8544 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8545 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8546 8547 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 8548 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8549 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(), 8550 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end(); 8551 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8552 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 8553 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 8554 continue; 8555 8556 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 8557 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8558 } 8559 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8560 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 8561 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 8562 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 8563 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum); 8564 8565 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined 8566 // candidate exists. 8567 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType).second || 8568 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType, 8569 CanonType))) 8570 continue; 8571 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum }; 8572 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8573 } 8574 } 8575 } 8576 8577 // C++ [over.built]p13: 8578 // 8579 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T 8580 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8581 // 8582 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); 8583 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW] 8584 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); 8585 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 8586 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW] 8587 // 8588 // C++ [over.built]p14: 8589 // 8590 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there 8591 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8592 // 8593 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 8594 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 8595 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8596 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8597 8598 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) { 8599 QualType AsymmetricParamTypes[2] = { 8600 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 8601 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 8602 }; 8603 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8604 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(), 8605 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end(); 8606 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8607 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 8608 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType()) 8609 continue; 8610 8611 AsymmetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr; 8612 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) { 8613 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t) 8614 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 8615 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(AsymmetricParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8616 } 8617 if (Op == OO_Minus) { 8618 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 8619 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 8620 continue; 8621 8622 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 8623 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8624 } 8625 } 8626 } 8627 } 8628 8629 // C++ [over.built]p12: 8630 // 8631 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there 8632 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8633 // 8634 // LR operator*(L, R); 8635 // LR operator/(L, R); 8636 // LR operator+(L, R); 8637 // LR operator-(L, R); 8638 // bool operator<(L, R); 8639 // bool operator>(L, R); 8640 // bool operator<=(L, R); 8641 // bool operator>=(L, R); 8642 // bool operator==(L, R); 8643 // bool operator!=(L, R); 8644 // 8645 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 8646 // between types L and R. 8647 // 8648 // C++ [over.built]p24: 8649 // 8650 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist 8651 // candidate operator functions of the form 8652 // 8653 // LR operator?(bool, L, R); 8654 // 8655 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 8656 // between types L and R. 8657 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter. 8658 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads() { 8659 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8660 return; 8661 8662 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8663 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) { 8664 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8665 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 8666 QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left], 8667 ArithmeticTypes[Right] }; 8668 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8669 } 8670 } 8671 8672 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the 8673 // conditional operator for vector types. 8674 for (QualType Vec1Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) 8675 for (QualType Vec2Ty : CandidateTypes[1].vector_types()) { 8676 QualType LandR[2] = {Vec1Ty, Vec2Ty}; 8677 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8678 } 8679 } 8680 8681 /// Add binary operator overloads for each candidate matrix type M1, M2: 8682 /// * (M1, M1) -> M1 8683 /// * (M1, M1.getElementType()) -> M1 8684 /// * (M2.getElementType(), M2) -> M2 8685 /// * (M2, M2) -> M2 // Only if M2 is not part of CandidateTypes[0]. 8686 void addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads() { 8687 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8688 return; 8689 8690 for (QualType M1 : CandidateTypes[0].matrix_types()) { 8691 AddCandidate(M1, cast<MatrixType>(M1)->getElementType()); 8692 AddCandidate(M1, M1); 8693 } 8694 8695 for (QualType M2 : CandidateTypes[1].matrix_types()) { 8696 AddCandidate(cast<MatrixType>(M2)->getElementType(), M2); 8697 if (!CandidateTypes[0].containsMatrixType(M2)) 8698 AddCandidate(M2, M2); 8699 } 8700 } 8701 8702 // C++2a [over.built]p14: 8703 // 8704 // For every integral type T there exists a candidate operator function 8705 // of the form 8706 // 8707 // std::strong_ordering operator<=>(T, T) 8708 // 8709 // C++2a [over.built]p15: 8710 // 8711 // For every pair of floating-point types L and R, there exists a candidate 8712 // operator function of the form 8713 // 8714 // std::partial_ordering operator<=>(L, R); 8715 // 8716 // FIXME: The current specification for integral types doesn't play nice with 8717 // the direction of p0946r0, which allows mixed integral and unscoped-enum 8718 // comparisons. Under the current spec this can lead to ambiguity during 8719 // overload resolution. For example: 8720 // 8721 // enum A : int {a}; 8722 // auto x = (a <=> (long)42); 8723 // 8724 // error: call is ambiguous for arguments 'A' and 'long'. 8725 // note: candidate operator<=>(int, int) 8726 // note: candidate operator<=>(long, long) 8727 // 8728 // To avoid this error, this function deviates from the specification and adds 8729 // the mixed overloads `operator<=>(L, R)` where L and R are promoted 8730 // arithmetic types (the same as the generic relational overloads). 8731 // 8732 // For now this function acts as a placeholder. 8733 void addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads() { 8734 addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 8735 } 8736 8737 // C++ [over.built]p17: 8738 // 8739 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there 8740 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8741 // 8742 // LR operator%(L, R); 8743 // LR operator&(L, R); 8744 // LR operator^(L, R); 8745 // LR operator|(L, R); 8746 // L operator<<(L, R); 8747 // L operator>>(L, R); 8748 // 8749 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 8750 // between types L and R. 8751 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 8752 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8753 return; 8754 8755 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8756 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) { 8757 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8758 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 8759 QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left], 8760 ArithmeticTypes[Right] }; 8761 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8762 } 8763 } 8764 } 8765 8766 // C++ [over.built]p20: 8767 // 8768 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or 8769 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or 8770 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8771 // 8772 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T); 8773 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() { 8774 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8775 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8776 8777 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 8778 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8779 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 8780 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 8781 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 8782 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)).second) 8783 continue; 8784 8785 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, CandidateSet); 8786 } 8787 8788 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8789 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 8790 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 8791 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 8792 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second) 8793 continue; 8794 8795 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, CandidateSet); 8796 } 8797 } 8798 } 8799 8800 // C++ [over.built]p19: 8801 // 8802 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either 8803 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions 8804 // of the form 8805 // 8806 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*); 8807 // 8808 // C++ [over.built]p21: 8809 // 8810 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 8811 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or 8812 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8813 // 8814 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 8815 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 8816 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) { 8817 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8818 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8819 8820 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8821 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8822 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8823 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8824 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added. 8825 if (isEqualOp) 8826 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)); 8827 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType()) 8828 continue; 8829 8830 // non-volatile version 8831 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 8832 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr), 8833 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 8834 }; 8835 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8836 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp); 8837 8838 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 8839 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(); 8840 if (NeedVolatile) { 8841 // volatile version 8842 ParamTypes[0] = 8843 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr)); 8844 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8845 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8846 } 8847 8848 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() && 8849 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) { 8850 // restrict version 8851 ParamTypes[0] 8852 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr)); 8853 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8854 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8855 8856 if (NeedVolatile) { 8857 // volatile restrict version 8858 ParamTypes[0] 8859 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8860 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr, 8861 (Qualifiers::Volatile | 8862 Qualifiers::Restrict))); 8863 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8864 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8865 } 8866 } 8867 } 8868 8869 if (isEqualOp) { 8870 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8871 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(), 8872 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end(); 8873 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8874 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice. 8875 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 8876 continue; 8877 8878 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 8879 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr), 8880 *Ptr, 8881 }; 8882 8883 // non-volatile version 8884 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8885 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8886 8887 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 8888 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(); 8889 if (NeedVolatile) { 8890 // volatile version 8891 ParamTypes[0] = 8892 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr)); 8893 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8894 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8895 } 8896 8897 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() && 8898 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) { 8899 // restrict version 8900 ParamTypes[0] 8901 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr)); 8902 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8903 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8904 8905 if (NeedVolatile) { 8906 // volatile restrict version 8907 ParamTypes[0] 8908 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8909 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr, 8910 (Qualifiers::Volatile | 8911 Qualifiers::Restrict))); 8912 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8913 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 8914 } 8915 } 8916 } 8917 } 8918 } 8919 8920 // C++ [over.built]p18: 8921 // 8922 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type, 8923 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted 8924 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of 8925 // the form 8926 // 8927 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R); 8928 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R); 8929 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R); 8930 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R); 8931 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R); 8932 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) { 8933 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8934 return; 8935 8936 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) { 8937 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8938 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 8939 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8940 ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right]; 8941 auto LeftBaseTy = AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType( 8942 S, ArithmeticTypes[Left], Args[0]); 8943 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 8944 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(LeftBaseTy); 8945 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8946 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8947 8948 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 8949 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 8950 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(LeftBaseTy); 8951 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 8952 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8953 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8954 } 8955 } 8956 } 8957 8958 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types. 8959 for (QualType Vec1Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) 8960 for (QualType Vec2Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) { 8961 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8962 ParamTypes[1] = Vec2Ty; 8963 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 8964 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(Vec1Ty); 8965 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8966 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8967 8968 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 8969 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 8970 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(Vec1Ty); 8971 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 8972 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8973 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8974 } 8975 } 8976 } 8977 8978 // C++ [over.built]p22: 8979 // 8980 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ 8981 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral 8982 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8983 // 8984 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R); 8985 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R); 8986 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R); 8987 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R); 8988 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R); 8989 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R); 8990 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() { 8991 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8992 return; 8993 8994 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) { 8995 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8996 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 8997 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8998 ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right]; 8999 auto LeftBaseTy = AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType( 9000 S, ArithmeticTypes[Left], Args[0]); 9001 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 9002 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(LeftBaseTy); 9003 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9004 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 9005 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 9006 ParamTypes[0] = LeftBaseTy; 9007 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]); 9008 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 9009 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9010 } 9011 } 9012 } 9013 } 9014 9015 // C++ [over.operator]p23: 9016 // 9017 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form 9018 // 9019 // bool operator!(bool); 9020 // bool operator&&(bool, bool); 9021 // bool operator||(bool, bool); 9022 void addExclaimOverload() { 9023 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy; 9024 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet, 9025 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 9026 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1); 9027 } 9028 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() { 9029 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy }; 9030 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 9031 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 9032 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2); 9033 } 9034 9035 // C++ [over.built]p13: 9036 // 9037 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there 9038 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 9039 // 9040 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 9041 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); 9042 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 9043 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE] 9044 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); 9045 void addSubscriptOverloads() { 9046 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 9047 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 9048 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 9049 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 9050 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() }; 9051 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 9052 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType()) 9053 continue; 9054 9055 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t) 9056 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9057 } 9058 9059 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 9060 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(), 9061 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end(); 9062 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 9063 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr }; 9064 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 9065 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType()) 9066 continue; 9067 9068 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*) 9069 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9070 } 9071 } 9072 9073 // C++ [over.built]p11: 9074 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type, 9075 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object 9076 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs, 9077 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 9078 // 9079 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*); 9080 // 9081 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2. 9082 void addArrowStarOverloads() { 9083 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 9084 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 9085 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 9086 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 9087 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr); 9088 QualType C1; 9089 QualifierCollector Q1; 9090 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0); 9091 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1)) 9092 continue; 9093 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set. 9094 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a 9095 // volatile/restrict type. 9096 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile()) 9097 continue; 9098 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict()) 9099 continue; 9100 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 9101 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(), 9102 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end(); 9103 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 9104 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr); 9105 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0); 9106 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType(); 9107 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), C1, C2)) 9108 break; 9109 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr }; 9110 // build CV12 T& 9111 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType(); 9112 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && 9113 T.isVolatileQualified()) 9114 continue; 9115 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && 9116 T.isRestrictQualified()) 9117 continue; 9118 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T); 9119 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9120 } 9121 } 9122 } 9123 9124 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been 9125 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are 9126 // therefore added as binary. 9127 // 9128 // C++ [over.built]p25: 9129 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped 9130 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 9131 // 9132 // T operator?(bool, T, T); 9133 // 9134 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() { 9135 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 9136 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 9137 9138 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 9139 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 9140 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(), 9141 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end(); 9142 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 9143 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 9144 continue; 9145 9146 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 9147 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9148 } 9149 9150 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 9151 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 9152 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 9153 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 9154 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second) 9155 continue; 9156 9157 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr }; 9158 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9159 } 9160 9161 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 9162 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 9163 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 9164 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 9165 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 9166 if (!(*Enum)->castAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped()) 9167 continue; 9168 9169 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)).second) 9170 continue; 9171 9172 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum }; 9173 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 9174 } 9175 } 9176 } 9177 } 9178 }; 9179 9180 } // end anonymous namespace 9181 9182 /// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in 9183 /// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based 9184 /// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the 9185 /// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int 9186 /// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition. 9187 void Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 9188 SourceLocation OpLoc, 9189 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 9190 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 9191 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only 9192 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates 9193 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record 9194 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types. 9195 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals; 9196 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst(); 9197 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) 9198 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]); 9199 9200 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false; 9201 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false; 9202 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes; 9203 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 9204 CandidateTypes.emplace_back(*this); 9205 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(), 9206 OpLoc, 9207 true, 9208 (Op == OO_Exclaim || 9209 Op == OO_AmpAmp || 9210 Op == OO_PipePipe), 9211 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 9212 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType || 9213 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes(); 9214 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = 9215 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType || 9216 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(); 9217 } 9218 9219 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set 9220 // for any of the arguments to the operator. 9221 // 9222 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have 9223 // 'bool' overloads. 9224 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType && 9225 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe)) 9226 return; 9227 9228 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads. 9229 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, 9230 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals, 9231 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType, 9232 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet); 9233 9234 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply. 9235 switch (Op) { 9236 case OO_None: 9237 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS: 9238 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator"); 9239 9240 case OO_New: 9241 case OO_Delete: 9242 case OO_Array_New: 9243 case OO_Array_Delete: 9244 case OO_Call: 9245 llvm_unreachable( 9246 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates"); 9247 9248 case OO_Comma: 9249 case OO_Arrow: 9250 case OO_Coawait: 9251 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 9252 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', the 9253 // operator '->', or the operator 'co_await', the 9254 // built-in candidates set is empty. 9255 break; 9256 9257 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary 9258 if (Args.size() == 1) 9259 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads(); 9260 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 9261 9262 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary 9263 if (Args.size() == 1) { 9264 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads(); 9265 } else { 9266 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op); 9267 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9268 OpBuilder.addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9269 } 9270 break; 9271 9272 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary 9273 if (Args.size() == 1) 9274 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads(); 9275 else { 9276 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9277 OpBuilder.addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9278 } 9279 break; 9280 9281 case OO_Slash: 9282 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9283 break; 9284 9285 case OO_PlusPlus: 9286 case OO_MinusMinus: 9287 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op); 9288 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads(); 9289 break; 9290 9291 case OO_EqualEqual: 9292 case OO_ExclaimEqual: 9293 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads(); 9294 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 9295 9296 case OO_Less: 9297 case OO_Greater: 9298 case OO_LessEqual: 9299 case OO_GreaterEqual: 9300 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 9301 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9302 break; 9303 9304 case OO_Spaceship: 9305 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 9306 OpBuilder.addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads(); 9307 break; 9308 9309 case OO_Percent: 9310 case OO_Caret: 9311 case OO_Pipe: 9312 case OO_LessLess: 9313 case OO_GreaterGreater: 9314 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op); 9315 break; 9316 9317 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary 9318 if (Args.size() == 1) 9319 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 9320 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the 9321 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty. 9322 break; 9323 9324 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op); 9325 break; 9326 9327 case OO_Tilde: 9328 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads(); 9329 break; 9330 9331 case OO_Equal: 9332 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 9333 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 9334 9335 case OO_PlusEqual: 9336 case OO_MinusEqual: 9337 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal); 9338 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 9339 9340 case OO_StarEqual: 9341 case OO_SlashEqual: 9342 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal); 9343 break; 9344 9345 case OO_PercentEqual: 9346 case OO_LessLessEqual: 9347 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual: 9348 case OO_AmpEqual: 9349 case OO_CaretEqual: 9350 case OO_PipeEqual: 9351 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads(); 9352 break; 9353 9354 case OO_Exclaim: 9355 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload(); 9356 break; 9357 9358 case OO_AmpAmp: 9359 case OO_PipePipe: 9360 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload(); 9361 break; 9362 9363 case OO_Subscript: 9364 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads(); 9365 break; 9366 9367 case OO_ArrowStar: 9368 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads(); 9369 break; 9370 9371 case OO_Conditional: 9372 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads(); 9373 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 9374 break; 9375 } 9376 } 9377 9378 /// Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup 9379 /// to the set of overloading candidates. 9380 /// 9381 /// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the 9382 /// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds 9383 /// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload 9384 /// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]). 9385 void 9386 Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name, 9387 SourceLocation Loc, 9388 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 9389 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 9390 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 9391 bool PartialOverloading) { 9392 ADLResult Fns; 9393 9394 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing 9395 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality, 9396 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However, 9397 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the 9398 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are 9399 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway? 9400 9401 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments? 9402 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Loc, Args, Fns); 9403 9404 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about. 9405 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(), 9406 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 9407 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand) 9408 if (Cand->Function) { 9409 Fns.erase(Cand->Function); 9410 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) 9411 Fns.erase(FunTmpl); 9412 } 9413 9414 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload 9415 // set. 9416 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) { 9417 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none); 9418 9419 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) { 9420 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) 9421 continue; 9422 9423 AddOverloadCandidate( 9424 FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 9425 PartialOverloading, /*AllowExplicit=*/true, 9426 /*AllowExplicitConversions=*/false, ADLCallKind::UsesADL); 9427 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD)) { 9428 AddOverloadCandidate( 9429 FD, FoundDecl, {Args[1], Args[0]}, CandidateSet, 9430 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading, 9431 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, /*AllowExplicitConversions=*/false, 9432 ADLCallKind::UsesADL, None, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 9433 } 9434 } else { 9435 auto *FTD = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I); 9436 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 9437 FTD, FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet, 9438 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading, 9439 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, ADLCallKind::UsesADL); 9440 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed( 9441 Context, FTD->getTemplatedDecl())) { 9442 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 9443 FTD, FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, {Args[1], Args[0]}, 9444 CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading, 9445 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, ADLCallKind::UsesADL, 9446 OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 9447 } 9448 } 9449 } 9450 } 9451 9452 namespace { 9453 enum class Comparison { Equal, Better, Worse }; 9454 } 9455 9456 /// Compares the enable_if attributes of two FunctionDecls, for the purposes of 9457 /// overload resolution. 9458 /// 9459 /// Cand1's set of enable_if attributes are said to be "better" than Cand2's iff 9460 /// Cand1's first N enable_if attributes have precisely the same conditions as 9461 /// Cand2's first N enable_if attributes (where N = the number of enable_if 9462 /// attributes on Cand2), and Cand1 has more than N enable_if attributes. 9463 /// 9464 /// Note that you can have a pair of candidates such that Cand1's enable_if 9465 /// attributes are worse than Cand2's, and Cand2's enable_if attributes are 9466 /// worse than Cand1's. 9467 static Comparison compareEnableIfAttrs(const Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *Cand1, 9468 const FunctionDecl *Cand2) { 9469 // Common case: One (or both) decls don't have enable_if attrs. 9470 bool Cand1Attr = Cand1->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>(); 9471 bool Cand2Attr = Cand2->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>(); 9472 if (!Cand1Attr || !Cand2Attr) { 9473 if (Cand1Attr == Cand2Attr) 9474 return Comparison::Equal; 9475 return Cand1Attr ? Comparison::Better : Comparison::Worse; 9476 } 9477 9478 auto Cand1Attrs = Cand1->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>(); 9479 auto Cand2Attrs = Cand2->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>(); 9480 9481 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID Cand1ID, Cand2ID; 9482 for (auto Pair : zip_longest(Cand1Attrs, Cand2Attrs)) { 9483 Optional<EnableIfAttr *> Cand1A = std::get<0>(Pair); 9484 Optional<EnableIfAttr *> Cand2A = std::get<1>(Pair); 9485 9486 // It's impossible for Cand1 to be better than (or equal to) Cand2 if Cand1 9487 // has fewer enable_if attributes than Cand2, and vice versa. 9488 if (!Cand1A) 9489 return Comparison::Worse; 9490 if (!Cand2A) 9491 return Comparison::Better; 9492 9493 Cand1ID.clear(); 9494 Cand2ID.clear(); 9495 9496 (*Cand1A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand1ID, S.getASTContext(), true); 9497 (*Cand2A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand2ID, S.getASTContext(), true); 9498 if (Cand1ID != Cand2ID) 9499 return Comparison::Worse; 9500 } 9501 9502 return Comparison::Equal; 9503 } 9504 9505 static Comparison 9506 isBetterMultiversionCandidate(const OverloadCandidate &Cand1, 9507 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2) { 9508 if (!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->isMultiVersion() || !Cand2.Function || 9509 !Cand2.Function->isMultiVersion()) 9510 return Comparison::Equal; 9511 9512 // If both are invalid, they are equal. If one of them is invalid, the other 9513 // is better. 9514 if (Cand1.Function->isInvalidDecl()) { 9515 if (Cand2.Function->isInvalidDecl()) 9516 return Comparison::Equal; 9517 return Comparison::Worse; 9518 } 9519 if (Cand2.Function->isInvalidDecl()) 9520 return Comparison::Better; 9521 9522 // If this is a cpu_dispatch/cpu_specific multiversion situation, prefer 9523 // cpu_dispatch, else arbitrarily based on the identifiers. 9524 bool Cand1CPUDisp = Cand1.Function->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 9525 bool Cand2CPUDisp = Cand2.Function->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>(); 9526 const auto *Cand1CPUSpec = Cand1.Function->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 9527 const auto *Cand2CPUSpec = Cand2.Function->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>(); 9528 9529 if (!Cand1CPUDisp && !Cand2CPUDisp && !Cand1CPUSpec && !Cand2CPUSpec) 9530 return Comparison::Equal; 9531 9532 if (Cand1CPUDisp && !Cand2CPUDisp) 9533 return Comparison::Better; 9534 if (Cand2CPUDisp && !Cand1CPUDisp) 9535 return Comparison::Worse; 9536 9537 if (Cand1CPUSpec && Cand2CPUSpec) { 9538 if (Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_size() != Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_size()) 9539 return Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_size() < Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_size() 9540 ? Comparison::Better 9541 : Comparison::Worse; 9542 9543 std::pair<CPUSpecificAttr::cpus_iterator, CPUSpecificAttr::cpus_iterator> 9544 FirstDiff = std::mismatch( 9545 Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_begin(), Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_end(), 9546 Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_begin(), 9547 [](const IdentifierInfo *LHS, const IdentifierInfo *RHS) { 9548 return LHS->getName() == RHS->getName(); 9549 }); 9550 9551 assert(FirstDiff.first != Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_end() && 9552 "Two different cpu-specific versions should not have the same " 9553 "identifier list, otherwise they'd be the same decl!"); 9554 return (*FirstDiff.first)->getName() < (*FirstDiff.second)->getName() 9555 ? Comparison::Better 9556 : Comparison::Worse; 9557 } 9558 llvm_unreachable("No way to get here unless both had cpu_dispatch"); 9559 } 9560 9561 /// Compute the type of the implicit object parameter for the given function, 9562 /// if any. Returns None if there is no implicit object parameter, and a null 9563 /// QualType if there is a 'matches anything' implicit object parameter. 9564 static Optional<QualType> getImplicitObjectParamType(ASTContext &Context, 9565 const FunctionDecl *F) { 9566 if (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(F) || isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(F)) 9567 return llvm::None; 9568 9569 auto *M = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(F); 9570 // Static member functions' object parameters match all types. 9571 if (M->isStatic()) 9572 return QualType(); 9573 9574 QualType T = M->getThisObjectType(); 9575 if (M->getRefQualifier() == RQ_RValue) 9576 return Context.getRValueReferenceType(T); 9577 return Context.getLValueReferenceType(T); 9578 } 9579 9580 static bool haveSameParameterTypes(ASTContext &Context, const FunctionDecl *F1, 9581 const FunctionDecl *F2, unsigned NumParams) { 9582 if (declaresSameEntity(F1, F2)) 9583 return true; 9584 9585 auto NextParam = [&](const FunctionDecl *F, unsigned &I, bool First) { 9586 if (First) { 9587 if (Optional<QualType> T = getImplicitObjectParamType(Context, F)) 9588 return *T; 9589 } 9590 assert(I < F->getNumParams()); 9591 return F->getParamDecl(I++)->getType(); 9592 }; 9593 9594 unsigned I1 = 0, I2 = 0; 9595 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumParams; ++I) { 9596 QualType T1 = NextParam(F1, I1, I == 0); 9597 QualType T2 = NextParam(F2, I2, I == 0); 9598 if (!T1.isNull() && !T1.isNull() && !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2)) 9599 return false; 9600 } 9601 return true; 9602 } 9603 9604 /// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload 9605 /// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1). 9606 bool clang::isBetterOverloadCandidate( 9607 Sema &S, const OverloadCandidate &Cand1, const OverloadCandidate &Cand2, 9608 SourceLocation Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind Kind) { 9609 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable 9610 // functions. 9611 if (!Cand2.Viable) 9612 return Cand1.Viable; 9613 else if (!Cand1.Viable) 9614 return false; 9615 9616 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 9617 // 9618 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such 9619 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for 9620 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither 9621 // better nor worse than ICS1(F). 9622 unsigned StartArg = 0; 9623 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument) 9624 StartArg = 1; 9625 9626 auto IsIllFormedConversion = [&](const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) { 9627 // We don't allow incompatible pointer conversions in C++. 9628 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 9629 return ICS.isStandard() && 9630 ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion; 9631 9632 // The only ill-formed conversion we allow in C++ is the string literal to 9633 // char* conversion, which is only considered ill-formed after C++11. 9634 return S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings && 9635 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS); 9636 }; 9637 9638 // Define functions that don't require ill-formed conversions for a given 9639 // argument to be better candidates than functions that do. 9640 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size(); 9641 assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch"); 9642 bool HasBetterConversion = false; 9643 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 9644 bool Cand1Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx]); 9645 bool Cand2Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx]); 9646 if (Cand1Bad != Cand2Bad) { 9647 if (Cand1Bad) 9648 return false; 9649 HasBetterConversion = true; 9650 } 9651 } 9652 9653 if (HasBetterConversion) 9654 return true; 9655 9656 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 9657 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another 9658 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse 9659 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then... 9660 bool HasWorseConversion = false; 9661 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 9662 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc, 9663 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx], 9664 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) { 9665 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 9666 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence. 9667 HasBetterConversion = true; 9668 break; 9669 9670 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 9671 if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 9672 Cand1.isReversed() != Cand2.isReversed() && 9673 haveSameParameterTypes(S.Context, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function, 9674 NumArgs)) { 9675 // Work around large-scale breakage caused by considering reversed 9676 // forms of operator== in C++20: 9677 // 9678 // When comparing a function against a reversed function with the same 9679 // parameter types, if we have a better conversion for one argument and 9680 // a worse conversion for the other, the implicit conversion sequences 9681 // are treated as being equally good. 9682 // 9683 // This prevents a comparison function from being considered ambiguous 9684 // with a reversed form that is written in the same way. 9685 // 9686 // We diagnose this as an extension from CreateOverloadedBinOp. 9687 HasWorseConversion = true; 9688 break; 9689 } 9690 9691 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2. 9692 return false; 9693 9694 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 9695 // Do nothing. 9696 break; 9697 } 9698 } 9699 9700 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than 9701 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that, 9702 if (HasBetterConversion && !HasWorseConversion) 9703 return true; 9704 9705 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion 9706 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence 9707 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e., 9708 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better 9709 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence 9710 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type. 9711 if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion && 9712 Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 9713 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) && 9714 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) { 9715 // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the 9716 // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension 9717 // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function 9718 // pointer or block. 9719 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result = 9720 compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function); 9721 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable) 9722 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc, 9723 Cand1.FinalConversion, 9724 Cand2.FinalConversion); 9725 9726 if (Result != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable) 9727 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 9728 9729 // FIXME: Compare kind of reference binding if conversion functions 9730 // convert to a reference type used in direct reference binding, per 9731 // C++14 [over.match.best]p1 section 2 bullet 3. 9732 } 9733 9734 // FIXME: Work around a defect in the C++17 guaranteed copy elision wording, 9735 // as combined with the resolution to CWG issue 243. 9736 // 9737 // When the context is initialization by constructor ([over.match.ctor] or 9738 // either phase of [over.match.list]), a constructor is preferred over 9739 // a conversion function. 9740 if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByConstructor && NumArgs == 1 && 9741 Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 9742 isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function) != 9743 isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand2.Function)) 9744 return isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function); 9745 9746 // -- F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template 9747 // specialization, or, if not that, 9748 bool Cand1IsSpecialization = Cand1.Function && 9749 Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 9750 bool Cand2IsSpecialization = Cand2.Function && 9751 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 9752 if (Cand1IsSpecialization != Cand2IsSpecialization) 9753 return Cand2IsSpecialization; 9754 9755 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function 9756 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2 9757 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or, 9758 // if not that, 9759 if (Cand1IsSpecialization && Cand2IsSpecialization) { 9760 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate( 9761 Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), 9762 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), Loc, 9763 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) ? TPOC_Conversion 9764 : TPOC_Call, 9765 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments, Cand2.ExplicitCallArguments, 9766 Cand1.isReversed() ^ Cand2.isReversed())) 9767 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 9768 } 9769 9770 // -— F1 and F2 are non-template functions with the same 9771 // parameter-type-lists, and F1 is more constrained than F2 [...], 9772 if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && !Cand1IsSpecialization && 9773 !Cand2IsSpecialization && Cand1.Function->hasPrototype() && 9774 Cand2.Function->hasPrototype()) { 9775 auto *PT1 = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Cand1.Function->getFunctionType()); 9776 auto *PT2 = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Cand2.Function->getFunctionType()); 9777 if (PT1->getNumParams() == PT2->getNumParams() && 9778 PT1->isVariadic() == PT2->isVariadic() && 9779 S.FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(PT1, PT2)) { 9780 Expr *RC1 = Cand1.Function->getTrailingRequiresClause(); 9781 Expr *RC2 = Cand2.Function->getTrailingRequiresClause(); 9782 if (RC1 && RC2) { 9783 bool AtLeastAsConstrained1, AtLeastAsConstrained2; 9784 if (S.IsAtLeastAsConstrained(Cand1.Function, {RC1}, Cand2.Function, 9785 {RC2}, AtLeastAsConstrained1) || 9786 S.IsAtLeastAsConstrained(Cand2.Function, {RC2}, Cand1.Function, 9787 {RC1}, AtLeastAsConstrained2)) 9788 return false; 9789 if (AtLeastAsConstrained1 != AtLeastAsConstrained2) 9790 return AtLeastAsConstrained1; 9791 } else if (RC1 || RC2) { 9792 return RC1 != nullptr; 9793 } 9794 } 9795 } 9796 9797 // -- F1 is a constructor for a class D, F2 is a constructor for a base 9798 // class B of D, and for all arguments the corresponding parameters of 9799 // F1 and F2 have the same type. 9800 // FIXME: Implement the "all parameters have the same type" check. 9801 bool Cand1IsInherited = 9802 dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand1.FoundDecl.getDecl()); 9803 bool Cand2IsInherited = 9804 dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand2.FoundDecl.getDecl()); 9805 if (Cand1IsInherited != Cand2IsInherited) 9806 return Cand2IsInherited; 9807 else if (Cand1IsInherited) { 9808 assert(Cand2IsInherited); 9809 auto *Cand1Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand1.Function->getDeclContext()); 9810 auto *Cand2Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand2.Function->getDeclContext()); 9811 if (Cand1Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand2Class)) 9812 return true; 9813 if (Cand2Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand1Class)) 9814 return false; 9815 // Inherited from sibling base classes: still ambiguous. 9816 } 9817 9818 // -- F2 is a rewritten candidate (12.4.1.2) and F1 is not 9819 // -- F1 and F2 are rewritten candidates, and F2 is a synthesized candidate 9820 // with reversed order of parameters and F1 is not 9821 // 9822 // We rank reversed + different operator as worse than just reversed, but 9823 // that comparison can never happen, because we only consider reversing for 9824 // the maximally-rewritten operator (== or <=>). 9825 if (Cand1.RewriteKind != Cand2.RewriteKind) 9826 return Cand1.RewriteKind < Cand2.RewriteKind; 9827 9828 // Check C++17 tie-breakers for deduction guides. 9829 { 9830 auto *Guide1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand1.Function); 9831 auto *Guide2 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand2.Function); 9832 if (Guide1 && Guide2) { 9833 // -- F1 is generated from a deduction-guide and F2 is not 9834 if (Guide1->isImplicit() != Guide2->isImplicit()) 9835 return Guide2->isImplicit(); 9836 9837 // -- F1 is the copy deduction candidate(16.3.1.8) and F2 is not 9838 if (Guide1->isCopyDeductionCandidate()) 9839 return true; 9840 } 9841 } 9842 9843 // Check for enable_if value-based overload resolution. 9844 if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) { 9845 Comparison Cmp = compareEnableIfAttrs(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function); 9846 if (Cmp != Comparison::Equal) 9847 return Cmp == Comparison::Better; 9848 } 9849 9850 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) { 9851 FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 9852 return S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand1.Function) > 9853 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand2.Function); 9854 } 9855 9856 bool HasPS1 = Cand1.Function != nullptr && 9857 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand1.Function); 9858 bool HasPS2 = Cand2.Function != nullptr && 9859 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand2.Function); 9860 if (HasPS1 != HasPS2 && HasPS1) 9861 return true; 9862 9863 Comparison MV = isBetterMultiversionCandidate(Cand1, Cand2); 9864 return MV == Comparison::Better; 9865 } 9866 9867 /// Determine whether two declarations are "equivalent" for the purposes of 9868 /// name lookup and overload resolution. This applies when the same internal/no 9869 /// linkage entity is defined by two modules (probably by textually including 9870 /// the same header). In such a case, we don't consider the declarations to 9871 /// declare the same entity, but we also don't want lookups with both 9872 /// declarations visible to be ambiguous in some cases (this happens when using 9873 /// a modularized libstdc++). 9874 bool Sema::isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(const NamedDecl *A, 9875 const NamedDecl *B) { 9876 auto *VA = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(A); 9877 auto *VB = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(B); 9878 if (!VA || !VB) 9879 return false; 9880 9881 // The declarations must be declaring the same name as an internal linkage 9882 // entity in different modules. 9883 if (!VA->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals( 9884 VB->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) || 9885 getOwningModule(VA) == getOwningModule(VB) || 9886 VA->isExternallyVisible() || VB->isExternallyVisible()) 9887 return false; 9888 9889 // Check that the declarations appear to be equivalent. 9890 // 9891 // FIXME: Checking the type isn't really enough to resolve the ambiguity. 9892 // For constants and functions, we should check the initializer or body is 9893 // the same. For non-constant variables, we shouldn't allow it at all. 9894 if (Context.hasSameType(VA->getType(), VB->getType())) 9895 return true; 9896 9897 // Enum constants within unnamed enumerations will have different types, but 9898 // may still be similar enough to be interchangeable for our purposes. 9899 if (auto *EA = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VA)) { 9900 if (auto *EB = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VB)) { 9901 // Only handle anonymous enums. If the enumerations were named and 9902 // equivalent, they would have been merged to the same type. 9903 auto *EnumA = cast<EnumDecl>(EA->getDeclContext()); 9904 auto *EnumB = cast<EnumDecl>(EB->getDeclContext()); 9905 if (EnumA->hasNameForLinkage() || EnumB->hasNameForLinkage() || 9906 !Context.hasSameType(EnumA->getIntegerType(), 9907 EnumB->getIntegerType())) 9908 return false; 9909 // Allow this only if the value is the same for both enumerators. 9910 return llvm::APSInt::isSameValue(EA->getInitVal(), EB->getInitVal()); 9911 } 9912 } 9913 9914 // Nothing else is sufficiently similar. 9915 return false; 9916 } 9917 9918 void Sema::diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations( 9919 SourceLocation Loc, const NamedDecl *D, ArrayRef<const NamedDecl *> Equiv) { 9920 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl_in_modules) << D; 9921 9922 Module *M = getOwningModule(D); 9923 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl) 9924 << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : ""); 9925 9926 for (auto *E : Equiv) { 9927 Module *M = getOwningModule(E); 9928 Diag(E->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl) 9929 << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : ""); 9930 } 9931 } 9932 9933 /// Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3) 9934 /// within an overload candidate set. 9935 /// 9936 /// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for 9937 /// which overload resolution occurs. 9938 /// 9939 /// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted 9940 /// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found. 9941 /// 9942 /// \returns The result of overload resolution. 9943 OverloadingResult 9944 OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9945 iterator &Best) { 9946 llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate *, 16> Candidates; 9947 std::transform(begin(), end(), std::back_inserter(Candidates), 9948 [](OverloadCandidate &Cand) { return &Cand; }); 9949 9950 // [CUDA] HD->H or HD->D calls are technically not allowed by CUDA but 9951 // are accepted by both clang and NVCC. However, during a particular 9952 // compilation mode only one call variant is viable. We need to 9953 // exclude non-viable overload candidates from consideration based 9954 // only on their host/device attributes. Specifically, if one 9955 // candidate call is WrongSide and the other is SameSide, we ignore 9956 // the WrongSide candidate. 9957 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA) { 9958 const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 9959 bool ContainsSameSideCandidate = 9960 llvm::any_of(Candidates, [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9961 // Check viable function only. 9962 return Cand->Viable && Cand->Function && 9963 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) == 9964 Sema::CFP_SameSide; 9965 }); 9966 if (ContainsSameSideCandidate) { 9967 auto IsWrongSideCandidate = [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9968 // Check viable function only to avoid unnecessary data copying/moving. 9969 return Cand->Viable && Cand->Function && 9970 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) == 9971 Sema::CFP_WrongSide; 9972 }; 9973 llvm::erase_if(Candidates, IsWrongSideCandidate); 9974 } 9975 } 9976 9977 // Find the best viable function. 9978 Best = end(); 9979 for (auto *Cand : Candidates) { 9980 Cand->Best = false; 9981 if (Cand->Viable) 9982 if (Best == end() || 9983 isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc, Kind)) 9984 Best = Cand; 9985 } 9986 9987 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort. 9988 if (Best == end()) 9989 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 9990 9991 llvm::SmallVector<const NamedDecl *, 4> EquivalentCands; 9992 9993 llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 4> PendingBest; 9994 PendingBest.push_back(&*Best); 9995 Best->Best = true; 9996 9997 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable 9998 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity. 9999 while (!PendingBest.empty()) { 10000 auto *Curr = PendingBest.pop_back_val(); 10001 for (auto *Cand : Candidates) { 10002 if (Cand->Viable && !Cand->Best && 10003 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Curr, *Cand, Loc, Kind)) { 10004 PendingBest.push_back(Cand); 10005 Cand->Best = true; 10006 10007 if (S.isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(Cand->Function, 10008 Curr->Function)) 10009 EquivalentCands.push_back(Cand->Function); 10010 else 10011 Best = end(); 10012 } 10013 } 10014 } 10015 10016 // If we found more than one best candidate, this is ambiguous. 10017 if (Best == end()) 10018 return OR_Ambiguous; 10019 10020 // Best is the best viable function. 10021 if (Best->Function && Best->Function->isDeleted()) 10022 return OR_Deleted; 10023 10024 if (!EquivalentCands.empty()) 10025 S.diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations(Loc, Best->Function, 10026 EquivalentCands); 10027 10028 return OR_Success; 10029 } 10030 10031 namespace { 10032 10033 enum OverloadCandidateKind { 10034 oc_function, 10035 oc_method, 10036 oc_reversed_binary_operator, 10037 oc_constructor, 10038 oc_implicit_default_constructor, 10039 oc_implicit_copy_constructor, 10040 oc_implicit_move_constructor, 10041 oc_implicit_copy_assignment, 10042 oc_implicit_move_assignment, 10043 oc_implicit_equality_comparison, 10044 oc_inherited_constructor 10045 }; 10046 10047 enum OverloadCandidateSelect { 10048 ocs_non_template, 10049 ocs_template, 10050 ocs_described_template, 10051 }; 10052 10053 static std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> 10054 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn, 10055 OverloadCandidateRewriteKind CRK, 10056 std::string &Description) { 10057 10058 bool isTemplate = Fn->isTemplateDecl() || Found->isTemplateDecl(); 10059 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) { 10060 isTemplate = true; 10061 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 10062 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs()); 10063 } 10064 10065 OverloadCandidateSelect Select = [&]() { 10066 if (!Description.empty()) 10067 return ocs_described_template; 10068 return isTemplate ? ocs_template : ocs_non_template; 10069 }(); 10070 10071 OverloadCandidateKind Kind = [&]() { 10072 if (Fn->isImplicit() && Fn->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_EqualEqual) 10073 return oc_implicit_equality_comparison; 10074 10075 if (CRK & CRK_Reversed) 10076 return oc_reversed_binary_operator; 10077 10078 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 10079 if (!Ctor->isImplicit()) { 10080 if (isa<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Found)) 10081 return oc_inherited_constructor; 10082 else 10083 return oc_constructor; 10084 } 10085 10086 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor()) 10087 return oc_implicit_default_constructor; 10088 10089 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor()) 10090 return oc_implicit_move_constructor; 10091 10092 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() && 10093 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor"); 10094 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor; 10095 } 10096 10097 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 10098 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but 10099 // it doesn't hurt to split it out. 10100 if (!Meth->isImplicit()) 10101 return oc_method; 10102 10103 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) 10104 return oc_implicit_move_assignment; 10105 10106 if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator()) 10107 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment; 10108 10109 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion"); 10110 return oc_method; 10111 } 10112 10113 return oc_function; 10114 }(); 10115 10116 return std::make_pair(Kind, Select); 10117 } 10118 10119 void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, Decl *FoundDecl) { 10120 // FIXME: It'd be nice to only emit a note once per using-decl per overload 10121 // set. 10122 if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl)) 10123 S.Diag(FoundDecl->getLocation(), 10124 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor) 10125 << Shadow->getNominatedBaseClass(); 10126 } 10127 10128 } // end anonymous namespace 10129 10130 static bool isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(const ASTContext &Ctx, 10131 const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10132 for (auto *EnableIf : FD->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>()) { 10133 bool AlwaysTrue; 10134 if (EnableIf->getCond()->isValueDependent() || 10135 !EnableIf->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(AlwaysTrue, Ctx)) 10136 return false; 10137 if (!AlwaysTrue) 10138 return false; 10139 } 10140 return true; 10141 } 10142 10143 /// Returns true if we can take the address of the function. 10144 /// 10145 /// \param Complain - If true, we'll emit a diagnostic 10146 /// \param InOverloadResolution - For the purposes of emitting a diagnostic, are 10147 /// we in overload resolution? 10148 /// \param Loc - The location of the statement we're complaining about. Ignored 10149 /// if we're not complaining, or if we're in overload resolution. 10150 static bool checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD, 10151 bool Complain, 10152 bool InOverloadResolution, 10153 SourceLocation Loc) { 10154 if (!isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(S.Context, FD)) { 10155 if (Complain) { 10156 if (InOverloadResolution) 10157 S.Diag(FD->getBeginLoc(), 10158 diag::note_addrof_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr); 10159 else 10160 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_addrof_function_disabled_by_enable_if_attr) << FD; 10161 } 10162 return false; 10163 } 10164 10165 if (FD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) { 10166 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 10167 if (S.CheckFunctionConstraints(FD, Satisfaction, Loc)) 10168 return false; 10169 if (!Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) { 10170 if (Complain) { 10171 if (InOverloadResolution) 10172 S.Diag(FD->getBeginLoc(), 10173 diag::note_ovl_candidate_unsatisfied_constraints); 10174 else 10175 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_addrof_function_constraints_not_satisfied) 10176 << FD; 10177 S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(Satisfaction); 10178 } 10179 return false; 10180 } 10181 } 10182 10183 auto I = llvm::find_if(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) { 10184 return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 10185 }); 10186 if (I == FD->param_end()) 10187 return true; 10188 10189 if (Complain) { 10190 // Add one to ParamNo because it's user-facing 10191 unsigned ParamNo = std::distance(FD->param_begin(), I) + 1; 10192 if (InOverloadResolution) 10193 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), 10194 diag::note_ovl_candidate_has_pass_object_size_params) 10195 << ParamNo; 10196 else 10197 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_address_of_function_with_pass_object_size_params) 10198 << FD << ParamNo; 10199 } 10200 return false; 10201 } 10202 10203 static bool checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(Sema &S, 10204 const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10205 return checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(S, FD, /*Complain=*/true, 10206 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 10207 /*Loc=*/SourceLocation()); 10208 } 10209 10210 bool Sema::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(const FunctionDecl *Function, 10211 bool Complain, 10212 SourceLocation Loc) { 10213 return ::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(*this, Function, Complain, 10214 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 10215 Loc); 10216 } 10217 10218 // Notes the location of an overload candidate. 10219 void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn, 10220 OverloadCandidateRewriteKind RewriteKind, 10221 QualType DestType, bool TakingAddress) { 10222 if (TakingAddress && !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(*this, Fn)) 10223 return; 10224 if (Fn->isMultiVersion() && Fn->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() && 10225 !Fn->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) 10226 return; 10227 if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Fn) && 10228 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Fn->getParent())->isLambda()) { 10229 // Don't print candidates other than the one that matches the calling 10230 // convention of the call operator, since that is guaranteed to exist. 10231 const auto *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Fn->getParent()); 10232 CXXMethodDecl *CallOp = RD->getLambdaCallOperator(); 10233 CallingConv CallOpCC = 10234 CallOp->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv(); 10235 CXXConversionDecl *ConvD = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Fn); 10236 QualType ConvRTy = ConvD->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(); 10237 CallingConv ConvToCC = 10238 ConvRTy->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv(); 10239 10240 if (ConvToCC != CallOpCC) 10241 return; 10242 } 10243 10244 std::string FnDesc; 10245 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> KSPair = 10246 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Found, Fn, RewriteKind, FnDesc); 10247 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) 10248 << (unsigned)KSPair.first << (unsigned)KSPair.second 10249 << Fn << FnDesc; 10250 10251 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType); 10252 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD); 10253 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Found); 10254 } 10255 10256 static void 10257 MaybeDiagnoseAmbiguousConstraints(Sema &S, ArrayRef<OverloadCandidate> Cands) { 10258 // Perhaps the ambiguity was caused by two atomic constraints that are 10259 // 'identical' but not equivalent: 10260 // 10261 // void foo() requires (sizeof(T) > 4) { } // #1 10262 // void foo() requires (sizeof(T) > 4) && T::value { } // #2 10263 // 10264 // The 'sizeof(T) > 4' constraints are seemingly equivalent and should cause 10265 // #2 to subsume #1, but these constraint are not considered equivalent 10266 // according to the subsumption rules because they are not the same 10267 // source-level construct. This behavior is quite confusing and we should try 10268 // to help the user figure out what happened. 10269 10270 SmallVector<const Expr *, 3> FirstAC, SecondAC; 10271 FunctionDecl *FirstCand = nullptr, *SecondCand = nullptr; 10272 for (auto I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) { 10273 if (!I->Function) 10274 continue; 10275 SmallVector<const Expr *, 3> AC; 10276 if (auto *Template = I->Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) 10277 Template->getAssociatedConstraints(AC); 10278 else 10279 I->Function->getAssociatedConstraints(AC); 10280 if (AC.empty()) 10281 continue; 10282 if (FirstCand == nullptr) { 10283 FirstCand = I->Function; 10284 FirstAC = AC; 10285 } else if (SecondCand == nullptr) { 10286 SecondCand = I->Function; 10287 SecondAC = AC; 10288 } else { 10289 // We have more than one pair of constrained functions - this check is 10290 // expensive and we'd rather not try to diagnose it. 10291 return; 10292 } 10293 } 10294 if (!SecondCand) 10295 return; 10296 // The diagnostic can only happen if there are associated constraints on 10297 // both sides (there needs to be some identical atomic constraint). 10298 if (S.MaybeEmitAmbiguousAtomicConstraintsDiagnostic(FirstCand, FirstAC, 10299 SecondCand, SecondAC)) 10300 // Just show the user one diagnostic, they'll probably figure it out 10301 // from here. 10302 return; 10303 } 10304 10305 // Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through 10306 // OverloadedExpr 10307 void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr *OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType, 10308 bool TakingAddress) { 10309 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 10310 10311 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr); 10312 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression; 10313 10314 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 10315 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 10316 I != IEnd; ++I) { 10317 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = 10318 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) { 10319 NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), CRK_None, DestType, 10320 TakingAddress); 10321 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun 10322 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) { 10323 NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, CRK_None, DestType, TakingAddress); 10324 } 10325 } 10326 } 10327 10328 /// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the 10329 /// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and 10330 /// target types of the conversion. 10331 void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion( 10332 Sema &S, 10333 SourceLocation CaretLoc, 10334 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const { 10335 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag) 10336 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType(); 10337 // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from 10338 // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for 10339 // refactoring here. 10340 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 10341 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 10342 AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E; 10343 for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) { 10344 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) 10345 break; 10346 ++CandsShown; 10347 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(I->first, I->second); 10348 } 10349 if (I != E) 10350 S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 10351 } 10352 10353 static void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10354 unsigned I, bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 10355 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I]; 10356 assert(Conv.isBad()); 10357 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function"); 10358 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 10359 10360 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a 10361 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the 10362 // conversion-slot index. 10363 bool isObjectArgument = false; 10364 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 10365 if (I == 0) 10366 isObjectArgument = true; 10367 else 10368 I--; 10369 } 10370 10371 std::string FnDesc; 10372 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 10373 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind(), 10374 FnDesc); 10375 10376 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr; 10377 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType(); 10378 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType(); 10379 10380 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 10381 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?"); 10382 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens(); 10383 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E)) 10384 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 10385 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName(); 10386 10387 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload) 10388 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10389 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << ToTy 10390 << Name << I + 1; 10391 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10392 return; 10393 } 10394 10395 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due 10396 // to a qualifier mismatch. 10397 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy); 10398 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy); 10399 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 10400 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType(); 10401 else { 10402 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches. 10403 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 10404 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 10405 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(); 10406 CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType(); 10407 } 10408 } 10409 10410 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() && 10411 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) { 10412 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers(); 10413 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers(); 10414 10415 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) { 10416 if (isObjectArgument) 10417 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace_this) 10418 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10419 << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 10420 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace(); 10421 else 10422 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace) 10423 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10424 << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 10425 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace() 10426 << ToTy->isReferenceType() << I + 1; 10427 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10428 return; 10429 } 10430 10431 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) { 10432 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership) 10433 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10434 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10435 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime() 10436 << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 10437 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10438 return; 10439 } 10440 10441 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) { 10442 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc) 10443 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10444 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10445 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr() 10446 << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 10447 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10448 return; 10449 } 10450 10451 if (FromQs.hasUnaligned() != ToQs.hasUnaligned()) { 10452 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_unaligned) 10453 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10454 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10455 << FromQs.hasUnaligned() << I + 1; 10456 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10457 return; 10458 } 10459 10460 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 10461 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch"); 10462 10463 if (isObjectArgument) { 10464 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this) 10465 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10466 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10467 << (CVR - 1); 10468 } else { 10469 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr) 10470 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10471 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10472 << (CVR - 1) << I + 1; 10473 } 10474 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10475 return; 10476 } 10477 10478 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since 10479 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful. 10480 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) { 10481 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument) 10482 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10483 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10484 << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 10485 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10486 return; 10487 } 10488 10489 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently, 10490 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered 10491 // the failure. 10492 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType(); 10493 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 10494 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 10495 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) { 10496 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it. 10497 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete) 10498 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10499 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10500 << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1 10501 << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind); 10502 10503 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10504 return; 10505 } 10506 10507 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions. 10508 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0; 10509 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 10510 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 10511 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 10512 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 10513 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 10514 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 10515 S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(), 10516 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType())) 10517 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1; 10518 } 10519 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy 10520 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 10521 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy 10522 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) 10523 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 10524 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 10525 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 10526 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 10527 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface)) 10528 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2; 10529 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 10530 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) && 10531 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() && 10532 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 10533 S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) { 10534 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3; 10535 } else if (ToTy->isLValueReferenceType() && !FromExpr->isLValue() && 10536 ToTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType() == 10537 FromTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType()) { 10538 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_lvalue) 10539 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10540 << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1 10541 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()); 10542 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10543 return; 10544 } 10545 } 10546 10547 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) { 10548 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv) 10549 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10550 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 10551 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1) << FromTy << ToTy << I + 1; 10552 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10553 return; 10554 } 10555 10556 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) && 10557 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) { 10558 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers(); 10559 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers(); 10560 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) { 10561 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv) 10562 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10563 << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 10564 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 10565 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10566 return; 10567 } 10568 } 10569 10570 if (TakingCandidateAddress && 10571 !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function)) 10572 return; 10573 10574 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it. 10575 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv); 10576 FDiag << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10577 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 10578 << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1 10579 << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind); 10580 10581 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts. 10582 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(), 10583 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI) 10584 FDiag << *HI; 10585 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag); 10586 10587 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10588 } 10589 10590 /// Additional arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload 10591 /// candidates. This is not covered by the more general DiagnoseArityMismatch() 10592 /// over a candidate in any candidate set. 10593 static bool CheckArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10594 unsigned NumArgs) { 10595 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 10596 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments(); 10597 10598 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we 10599 // have an arity mismatch when in fact it looks like we have the 10600 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have 10601 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions. 10602 // Just don't report anything. 10603 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() && 10604 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName) 10605 return true; 10606 10607 if (NumArgs < MinParams) { 10608 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) || 10609 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 10610 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments)); 10611 } else { 10612 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) || 10613 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 10614 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments)); 10615 } 10616 10617 return false; 10618 } 10619 10620 /// General arity mismatch diagnosis over a candidate in a candidate set. 10621 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *D, 10622 unsigned NumFormalArgs) { 10623 assert(isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 10624 "The templated declaration should at least be a function" 10625 " when diagnosing bad template argument deduction due to too many" 10626 " or too few arguments"); 10627 10628 FunctionDecl *Fn = cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 10629 10630 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case 10631 const auto *FnTy = Fn->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 10632 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments(); 10633 10634 // at least / at most / exactly 10635 unsigned mode, modeCount; 10636 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) { 10637 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams() || FnTy->isVariadic() || 10638 FnTy->isTemplateVariadic()) 10639 mode = 0; // "at least" 10640 else 10641 mode = 2; // "exactly" 10642 modeCount = MinParams; 10643 } else { 10644 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams()) 10645 mode = 1; // "at most" 10646 else 10647 mode = 2; // "exactly" 10648 modeCount = FnTy->getNumParams(); 10649 } 10650 10651 std::string Description; 10652 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 10653 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Found, Fn, CRK_None, Description); 10654 10655 if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName()) 10656 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one) 10657 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10658 << Description << mode << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs; 10659 else 10660 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity) 10661 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 10662 << Description << mode << modeCount << NumFormalArgs; 10663 10664 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10665 } 10666 10667 /// Arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload candidate. 10668 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10669 unsigned NumFormalArgs) { 10670 if (!CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumFormalArgs)) 10671 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, NumFormalArgs); 10672 } 10673 10674 static TemplateDecl *getDescribedTemplate(Decl *Templated) { 10675 if (TemplateDecl *TD = Templated->getDescribedTemplate()) 10676 return TD; 10677 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported: Getting the described template declaration" 10678 " for bad deduction diagnosis"); 10679 } 10680 10681 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction. 10682 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *Templated, 10683 DeductionFailureInfo &DeductionFailure, 10684 unsigned NumArgs, 10685 bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 10686 TemplateParameter Param = DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter(); 10687 NamedDecl *ParamD; 10688 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) || 10689 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) || 10690 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>()); 10691 switch (DeductionFailure.Result) { 10692 case Sema::TDK_Success: 10693 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction"); 10694 10695 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: { 10696 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result"); 10697 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10698 diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction) 10699 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 10700 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10701 return; 10702 } 10703 10704 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: { 10705 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result"); 10706 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10707 diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction_pack) 10708 << ParamD->getDeclName() 10709 << (DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->pack_size() + 1) 10710 << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg(); 10711 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10712 return; 10713 } 10714 10715 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 10716 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result"); 10717 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD); 10718 10719 QualType Param = DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType(); 10720 10721 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a 10722 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that. 10723 QualifierCollector Qs; 10724 Qs.strip(Param); 10725 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl()); 10726 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam)); 10727 10728 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do 10729 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't 10730 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't 10731 // done on dependent types). 10732 QualType Arg = DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType(); 10733 10734 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified) 10735 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam; 10736 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10737 return; 10738 } 10739 10740 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: { 10741 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result"); 10742 int which = 0; 10743 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 10744 which = 0; 10745 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) { 10746 // Deduction might have failed because we deduced arguments of two 10747 // different types for a non-type template parameter. 10748 // FIXME: Use a different TDK value for this. 10749 QualType T1 = 10750 DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType(); 10751 QualType T2 = 10752 DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType(); 10753 if (!T1.isNull() && !T2.isNull() && !S.Context.hasSameType(T1, T2)) { 10754 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10755 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction_types) 10756 << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << T1 10757 << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg() << T2; 10758 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10759 return; 10760 } 10761 10762 which = 1; 10763 } else { 10764 which = 2; 10765 } 10766 10767 // Tweak the diagnostic if the problem is that we deduced packs of 10768 // different arities. We'll print the actual packs anyway in case that 10769 // includes additional useful information. 10770 if (DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Pack && 10771 DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Pack && 10772 DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->pack_size() != 10773 DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->pack_size()) { 10774 which = 3; 10775 } 10776 10777 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10778 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction) 10779 << which << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() 10780 << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg(); 10781 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10782 return; 10783 } 10784 10785 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 10786 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments"); 10787 if (ParamD->getDeclName()) 10788 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10789 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named) 10790 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 10791 else { 10792 int index = 0; 10793 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 10794 index = TTP->getIndex(); 10795 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP 10796 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) 10797 index = NTTP->getIndex(); 10798 else 10799 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex(); 10800 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10801 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed) 10802 << (index + 1); 10803 } 10804 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10805 return; 10806 10807 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: { 10808 // Format the template argument list into the argument string. 10809 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString; 10810 TemplateArgumentList *Args = DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList(); 10811 TemplateArgString = " "; 10812 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 10813 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args); 10814 if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1) 10815 TemplateArgString.clear(); 10816 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10817 diag::note_ovl_candidate_unsatisfied_constraints) 10818 << TemplateArgString; 10819 10820 S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint( 10821 static_cast<CNSInfo*>(DeductionFailure.Data)->Satisfaction); 10822 return; 10823 } 10824 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 10825 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 10826 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Found, Templated, NumArgs); 10827 return; 10828 10829 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 10830 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10831 diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth); 10832 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10833 return; 10834 10835 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: { 10836 // Format the template argument list into the argument string. 10837 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString; 10838 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args = 10839 DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) { 10840 TemplateArgString = " "; 10841 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 10842 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args); 10843 if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1) 10844 TemplateArgString.clear(); 10845 } 10846 10847 // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so. 10848 PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic(); 10849 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() == 10850 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) { 10851 // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified 10852 // name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag. 10853 S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if) 10854 << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString; 10855 return; 10856 } 10857 10858 // We found a specific requirement that disabled the enable_if. 10859 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() == 10860 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_requirement) { 10861 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10862 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_requirement) 10863 << PDiag->second.getStringArg(0) << TemplateArgString; 10864 return; 10865 } 10866 10867 // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string. 10868 // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s 10869 // formatted message in another diagnostic. 10870 SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString; 10871 SourceRange R; 10872 if (PDiag) { 10873 SFINAEArgString = ": "; 10874 R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first); 10875 PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString); 10876 } 10877 10878 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10879 diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure) 10880 << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R; 10881 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10882 return; 10883 } 10884 10885 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 10886 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: { 10887 // Format the template argument list into the argument string. 10888 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString; 10889 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args = 10890 DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) { 10891 TemplateArgString = " "; 10892 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 10893 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args); 10894 if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1) 10895 TemplateArgString.clear(); 10896 } 10897 10898 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deduced_mismatch) 10899 << (*DeductionFailure.getCallArgIndex() + 1) 10900 << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg() 10901 << TemplateArgString 10902 << (DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested); 10903 break; 10904 } 10905 10906 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: { 10907 // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match. 10908 TemplateArgument FirstTA = *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg(); 10909 TemplateArgument SecondTA = *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg(); 10910 if (FirstTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template && 10911 SecondTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template) { 10912 TemplateName FirstTN = FirstTA.getAsTemplate(); 10913 TemplateName SecondTN = SecondTA.getAsTemplate(); 10914 if (FirstTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template && 10915 SecondTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template) { 10916 if (FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName() == 10917 SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName()) { 10918 // FIXME: This fixes a bad diagnostic where both templates are named 10919 // the same. This particular case is a bit difficult since: 10920 // 1) It is passed as a string to the diagnostic printer. 10921 // 2) The diagnostic printer only attempts to find a better 10922 // name for types, not decls. 10923 // Ideally, this should folded into the diagnostic printer. 10924 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10925 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch_qualified) 10926 << FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl() << SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl(); 10927 return; 10928 } 10929 } 10930 } 10931 10932 if (TakingCandidateAddress && isa<FunctionDecl>(Templated) && 10933 !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, cast<FunctionDecl>(Templated))) 10934 return; 10935 10936 // FIXME: For generic lambda parameters, check if the function is a lambda 10937 // call operator, and if so, emit a prettier and more informative 10938 // diagnostic that mentions 'auto' and lambda in addition to 10939 // (or instead of?) the canonical template type parameters. 10940 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10941 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch) 10942 << FirstTA << SecondTA; 10943 return; 10944 } 10945 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off 10946 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague. 10947 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 10948 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction); 10949 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10950 return; 10951 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 10952 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10953 diag::note_cuda_ovl_candidate_target_mismatch); 10954 return; 10955 } 10956 } 10957 10958 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction, for function calls. 10959 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10960 unsigned NumArgs, 10961 bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 10962 unsigned TDK = Cand->DeductionFailure.Result; 10963 if (TDK == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments || TDK == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments) { 10964 if (CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs)) 10965 return; 10966 } 10967 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, // pattern 10968 Cand->DeductionFailure, NumArgs, TakingCandidateAddress); 10969 } 10970 10971 /// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets. 10972 static void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10973 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 10974 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 10975 10976 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller), 10977 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee); 10978 10979 std::string FnDesc; 10980 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 10981 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Callee, 10982 Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc); 10983 10984 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target) 10985 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)ocs_non_template 10986 << FnDesc /* Ignored */ 10987 << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget; 10988 10989 // This could be an implicit constructor for which we could not infer the 10990 // target due to a collsion. Diagnose that case. 10991 CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Callee); 10992 if (Meth != nullptr && Meth->isImplicit()) { 10993 CXXRecordDecl *ParentClass = Meth->getParent(); 10994 Sema::CXXSpecialMember CSM; 10995 10996 switch (FnKindPair.first) { 10997 default: 10998 return; 10999 case oc_implicit_default_constructor: 11000 CSM = Sema::CXXDefaultConstructor; 11001 break; 11002 case oc_implicit_copy_constructor: 11003 CSM = Sema::CXXCopyConstructor; 11004 break; 11005 case oc_implicit_move_constructor: 11006 CSM = Sema::CXXMoveConstructor; 11007 break; 11008 case oc_implicit_copy_assignment: 11009 CSM = Sema::CXXCopyAssignment; 11010 break; 11011 case oc_implicit_move_assignment: 11012 CSM = Sema::CXXMoveAssignment; 11013 break; 11014 }; 11015 11016 bool ConstRHS = false; 11017 if (Meth->getNumParams()) { 11018 if (const ReferenceType *RT = 11019 Meth->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 11020 ConstRHS = RT->getPointeeType().isConstQualified(); 11021 } 11022 } 11023 11024 S.inferCUDATargetForImplicitSpecialMember(ParentClass, CSM, Meth, 11025 /* ConstRHS */ ConstRHS, 11026 /* Diagnose */ true); 11027 } 11028 } 11029 11030 static void DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11031 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 11032 EnableIfAttr *Attr = static_cast<EnableIfAttr*>(Cand->DeductionFailure.Data); 11033 11034 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), 11035 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr) 11036 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 11037 } 11038 11039 static void DiagnoseFailedExplicitSpec(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11040 ExplicitSpecifier ES = ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(Cand->Function); 11041 assert(ES.isExplicit() && "not an explicit candidate"); 11042 11043 unsigned Kind; 11044 switch (Cand->Function->getDeclKind()) { 11045 case Decl::Kind::CXXConstructor: 11046 Kind = 0; 11047 break; 11048 case Decl::Kind::CXXConversion: 11049 Kind = 1; 11050 break; 11051 case Decl::Kind::CXXDeductionGuide: 11052 Kind = Cand->Function->isImplicit() ? 0 : 2; 11053 break; 11054 default: 11055 llvm_unreachable("invalid Decl"); 11056 } 11057 11058 // Note the location of the first (in-class) declaration; a redeclaration 11059 // (particularly an out-of-class definition) will typically lack the 11060 // 'explicit' specifier. 11061 // FIXME: This is probably a good thing to do for all 'candidate' notes. 11062 FunctionDecl *First = Cand->Function->getFirstDecl(); 11063 if (FunctionDecl *Pattern = First->getTemplateInstantiationPattern()) 11064 First = Pattern->getFirstDecl(); 11065 11066 S.Diag(First->getLocation(), 11067 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit) 11068 << Kind << (ES.getExpr() ? 1 : 0) 11069 << (ES.getExpr() ? ES.getExpr()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()); 11070 } 11071 11072 static void DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11073 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 11074 11075 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), 11076 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_extension) 11077 << S.getOpenCLExtensionsFromDeclExtMap(Callee); 11078 } 11079 11080 /// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've 11081 /// already generated a primary error at the call site. 11082 /// 11083 /// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret 11084 /// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some 11085 /// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing 11086 /// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still 11087 /// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed 11088 /// overload. 11089 /// 11090 /// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems 11091 /// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd 11092 /// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics. 11093 /// \param CtorDestAS Addr space of object being constructed (for ctor 11094 /// candidates only). 11095 static void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 11096 unsigned NumArgs, 11097 bool TakingCandidateAddress, 11098 LangAS CtorDestAS = LangAS::Default) { 11099 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 11100 11101 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable. 11102 if (Cand->Viable) { 11103 if (Fn->isDeleted()) { 11104 std::string FnDesc; 11105 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 11106 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, 11107 Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc); 11108 11109 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted) 11110 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 11111 << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0); 11112 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 11113 return; 11114 } 11115 11116 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates. 11117 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind()); 11118 return; 11119 } 11120 11121 switch (Cand->FailureKind) { 11122 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments: 11123 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments: 11124 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs); 11125 11126 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction: 11127 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs, 11128 TakingCandidateAddress); 11129 11130 case ovl_fail_illegal_constructor: { 11131 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor) 11132 << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0); 11133 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 11134 return; 11135 } 11136 11137 case ovl_fail_object_addrspace_mismatch: { 11138 Qualifiers QualsForPrinting; 11139 QualsForPrinting.setAddressSpace(CtorDestAS); 11140 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 11141 diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor_adrspace_mismatch) 11142 << QualsForPrinting; 11143 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 11144 return; 11145 } 11146 11147 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion: 11148 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion: 11149 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact: 11150 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind()); 11151 11152 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: { 11153 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); 11154 for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I) 11155 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad()) 11156 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I, TakingCandidateAddress); 11157 11158 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit 11159 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle 11160 // those conditions and diagnose them well. 11161 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind()); 11162 } 11163 11164 case ovl_fail_bad_target: 11165 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand); 11166 11167 case ovl_fail_enable_if: 11168 return DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(S, Cand); 11169 11170 case ovl_fail_explicit: 11171 return DiagnoseFailedExplicitSpec(S, Cand); 11172 11173 case ovl_fail_ext_disabled: 11174 return DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(S, Cand); 11175 11176 case ovl_fail_inhctor_slice: 11177 // It's generally not interesting to note copy/move constructors here. 11178 if (cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)->isCopyOrMoveConstructor()) 11179 return; 11180 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 11181 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor_slice) 11182 << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0) 11183 << Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isRValueReferenceType(); 11184 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 11185 return; 11186 11187 case ovl_fail_addr_not_available: { 11188 bool Available = checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function); 11189 (void)Available; 11190 assert(!Available); 11191 break; 11192 } 11193 case ovl_non_default_multiversion_function: 11194 // Do nothing, these should simply be ignored. 11195 break; 11196 11197 case ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied: { 11198 std::string FnDesc; 11199 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 11200 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, 11201 Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc); 11202 11203 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 11204 diag::note_ovl_candidate_constraints_not_satisfied) 11205 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)ocs_non_template 11206 << FnDesc /* Ignored */; 11207 ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction; 11208 if (S.CheckFunctionConstraints(Fn, Satisfaction)) 11209 break; 11210 S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(Satisfaction); 11211 } 11212 } 11213 } 11214 11215 static void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11216 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type, 11217 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing 11218 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types). 11219 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType(); 11220 bool isLValueReference = false; 11221 bool isRValueReference = false; 11222 bool isPointer = false; 11223 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 11224 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) { 11225 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 11226 isLValueReference = true; 11227 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 11228 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) { 11229 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 11230 isRValueReference = true; 11231 } 11232 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 11233 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 11234 isPointer = true; 11235 } 11236 // Desugar down to a function type. 11237 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0); 11238 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate. 11239 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType); 11240 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType); 11241 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType); 11242 11243 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand) 11244 << FnType; 11245 } 11246 11247 static void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S, StringRef Opc, 11248 SourceLocation OpLoc, 11249 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11250 assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary"); 11251 std::string TypeStr("operator"); 11252 TypeStr += Opc; 11253 TypeStr += "("; 11254 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[0].getAsString(); 11255 if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) { 11256 TypeStr += ")"; 11257 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_candidate) << TypeStr; 11258 } else { 11259 TypeStr += ", "; 11260 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[1].getAsString(); 11261 TypeStr += ")"; 11262 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_candidate) << TypeStr; 11263 } 11264 } 11265 11266 static void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 11267 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11268 for (const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS : Cand->Conversions) { 11269 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid 11270 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue; 11271 11272 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion( 11273 S, OpLoc, S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion)); 11274 } 11275 } 11276 11277 static SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 11278 if (Cand->Function) 11279 return Cand->Function->getLocation(); 11280 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 11281 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(); 11282 return SourceLocation(); 11283 } 11284 11285 static unsigned RankDeductionFailure(const DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) { 11286 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) { 11287 case Sema::TDK_Success: 11288 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 11289 llvm_unreachable("non-deduction failure while diagnosing bad deduction"); 11290 11291 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 11292 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 11293 case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: 11294 return 1; 11295 11296 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 11297 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 11298 return 2; 11299 11300 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 11301 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 11302 case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: 11303 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 11304 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 11305 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 11306 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 11307 return 3; 11308 11309 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 11310 return 4; 11311 11312 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 11313 return 5; 11314 11315 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 11316 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 11317 return 6; 11318 } 11319 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result"); 11320 } 11321 11322 namespace { 11323 struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay { 11324 Sema &S; 11325 SourceLocation Loc; 11326 size_t NumArgs; 11327 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK; 11328 11329 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay( 11330 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, size_t NArgs, 11331 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK) 11332 : S(S), NumArgs(NArgs), CSK(CSK) {} 11333 11334 OverloadFailureKind EffectiveFailureKind(const OverloadCandidate *C) const { 11335 // If there are too many or too few arguments, that's the high-order bit we 11336 // want to sort by, even if the immediate failure kind was something else. 11337 if (C->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 11338 C->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) 11339 return static_cast<OverloadFailureKind>(C->FailureKind); 11340 11341 if (C->Function) { 11342 if (NumArgs > C->Function->getNumParams() && !C->Function->isVariadic()) 11343 return ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 11344 if (NumArgs < C->Function->getMinRequiredArguments()) 11345 return ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 11346 } 11347 11348 return static_cast<OverloadFailureKind>(C->FailureKind); 11349 } 11350 11351 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L, 11352 const OverloadCandidate *R) { 11353 // Fast-path this check. 11354 if (L == R) return false; 11355 11356 // Order first by viability. 11357 if (L->Viable) { 11358 if (!R->Viable) return true; 11359 11360 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload 11361 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort 11362 // that could exploit it. 11363 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation(), CSK)) 11364 return true; 11365 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation(), CSK)) 11366 return false; 11367 } else if (R->Viable) 11368 return false; 11369 11370 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable); 11371 11372 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates: 11373 if (!L->Viable) { 11374 OverloadFailureKind LFailureKind = EffectiveFailureKind(L); 11375 OverloadFailureKind RFailureKind = EffectiveFailureKind(R); 11376 11377 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates. 11378 if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 11379 LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) { 11380 if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 11381 RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) { 11382 int LDist = std::abs((int)L->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs); 11383 int RDist = std::abs((int)R->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs); 11384 if (LDist == RDist) { 11385 if (LFailureKind == RFailureKind) 11386 // Sort non-surrogates before surrogates. 11387 return !L->IsSurrogate && R->IsSurrogate; 11388 // Sort candidates requiring fewer parameters than there were 11389 // arguments given after candidates requiring more parameters 11390 // than there were arguments given. 11391 return LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 11392 } 11393 return LDist < RDist; 11394 } 11395 return false; 11396 } 11397 if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 11398 RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) 11399 return true; 11400 11401 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number 11402 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions. 11403 if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) { 11404 if (RFailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 11405 return true; 11406 11407 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes, 11408 // comes first. 11409 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed; 11410 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed; 11411 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes; 11412 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes; 11413 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) { 11414 return numLFixes < numRFixes; 11415 } 11416 11417 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions... 11418 // FIXME: this might not be transitive. 11419 assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size()); 11420 11421 int leftBetter = 0; 11422 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument); 11423 for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) { 11424 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc, 11425 L->Conversions[I], 11426 R->Conversions[I])) { 11427 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 11428 leftBetter++; 11429 break; 11430 11431 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 11432 leftBetter--; 11433 break; 11434 11435 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 11436 break; 11437 } 11438 } 11439 if (leftBetter > 0) return true; 11440 if (leftBetter < 0) return false; 11441 11442 } else if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 11443 return false; 11444 11445 if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) { 11446 if (RFailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 11447 return true; 11448 11449 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result) 11450 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) 11451 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure); 11452 } else if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 11453 return false; 11454 11455 // TODO: others? 11456 } 11457 11458 // Sort everything else by location. 11459 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L); 11460 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R); 11461 11462 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end. 11463 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false; 11464 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true; 11465 11466 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc); 11467 } 11468 }; 11469 } 11470 11471 /// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only 11472 /// computes up to the first bad conversion. Produces the FixIt set if 11473 /// possible. 11474 static void 11475 CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 11476 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11477 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK) { 11478 assert(!Cand->Viable); 11479 11480 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion. 11481 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 11482 return; 11483 11484 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected. 11485 bool Unfixable = false; 11486 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes. 11487 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization); 11488 11489 // Attempt to fix the bad conversion. 11490 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size(); 11491 for (unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); /**/; 11492 ++ConvIdx) { 11493 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate"); 11494 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() && 11495 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 11496 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S); 11497 break; 11498 } 11499 } 11500 11501 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload 11502 // operation somehow. 11503 bool SuppressUserConversions = false; 11504 11505 unsigned ConvIdx = 0; 11506 unsigned ArgIdx = 0; 11507 ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes; 11508 bool Reversed = Cand->isReversed(); 11509 11510 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) { 11511 QualType ConvType 11512 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 11513 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 11514 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 11515 ParamTypes = ConvType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes(); 11516 // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter. 11517 ConvIdx = 1; 11518 } else if (Cand->Function) { 11519 ParamTypes = 11520 Cand->Function->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes(); 11521 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) && 11522 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function) && !Reversed) { 11523 // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter. 11524 ConvIdx = 1; 11525 if (CSK == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator && 11526 Cand->Function->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_Call) 11527 // Argument 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter. 11528 ArgIdx = 1; 11529 } 11530 } else { 11531 // Builtin operator. 11532 assert(ConvCount <= 3); 11533 ParamTypes = Cand->BuiltinParamTypes; 11534 } 11535 11536 // Fill in the rest of the conversions. 11537 for (unsigned ParamIdx = Reversed ? ParamTypes.size() - 1 : 0; 11538 ConvIdx != ConvCount; 11539 ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx, ParamIdx += (Reversed ? -1 : 1)) { 11540 assert(ArgIdx < Args.size() && "no argument for this arg conversion"); 11541 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) { 11542 // We've already checked this conversion. 11543 } else if (ParamIdx < ParamTypes.size()) { 11544 if (ParamTypes[ParamIdx]->isDependentType()) 11545 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setAsIdentityConversion( 11546 Args[ArgIdx]->getType()); 11547 else { 11548 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] = 11549 TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTypes[ParamIdx], 11550 SuppressUserConversions, 11551 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 11552 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 11553 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 11554 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists. 11555 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) 11556 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S); 11557 } 11558 } else 11559 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis(); 11560 } 11561 } 11562 11563 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate *, 32> OverloadCandidateSet::CompleteCandidates( 11564 Sema &S, OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11565 SourceLocation OpLoc, 11566 llvm::function_ref<bool(OverloadCandidate &)> Filter) { 11567 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would 11568 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those. 11569 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands; 11570 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size()); 11571 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) { 11572 if (!Filter(*Cand)) 11573 continue; 11574 switch (OCD) { 11575 case OCD_AllCandidates: 11576 if (!Cand->Viable) { 11577 if (!Cand->Function && !Cand->IsSurrogate) { 11578 // This a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general, 11579 // want to list every possible builtin candidate. 11580 continue; 11581 } 11582 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args, Kind); 11583 } 11584 break; 11585 11586 case OCD_ViableCandidates: 11587 if (!Cand->Viable) 11588 continue; 11589 break; 11590 11591 case OCD_AmbiguousCandidates: 11592 if (!Cand->Best) 11593 continue; 11594 break; 11595 } 11596 11597 Cands.push_back(Cand); 11598 } 11599 11600 llvm::stable_sort( 11601 Cands, CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S, OpLoc, Args.size(), Kind)); 11602 11603 return Cands; 11604 } 11605 11606 /// When overload resolution fails, prints diagnostic messages containing the 11607 /// candidates in the candidate set. 11608 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(PartialDiagnosticAt PD, 11609 Sema &S, OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11610 StringRef Opc, SourceLocation OpLoc, 11611 llvm::function_ref<bool(OverloadCandidate &)> Filter) { 11612 11613 bool DeferHint = false; 11614 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && S.getLangOpts().GPUDeferDiag) { 11615 // Defer diagnostic for CUDA/HIP if there are wrong-sided candidates. 11616 auto WrongSidedCands = 11617 CompleteCandidates(S, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, OpLoc, [](auto &Cand) { 11618 return Cand.Viable == false && 11619 Cand.FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_target; 11620 }); 11621 DeferHint = WrongSidedCands.size(); 11622 } 11623 auto Cands = CompleteCandidates(S, OCD, Args, OpLoc, Filter); 11624 11625 S.Diag(PD.first, PD.second, DeferHint); 11626 11627 NoteCandidates(S, Args, Cands, Opc, OpLoc); 11628 11629 if (OCD == OCD_AmbiguousCandidates) 11630 MaybeDiagnoseAmbiguousConstraints(S, {begin(), end()}); 11631 } 11632 11633 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11634 ArrayRef<OverloadCandidate *> Cands, 11635 StringRef Opc, SourceLocation OpLoc) { 11636 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false; 11637 11638 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 11639 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 11640 auto I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); 11641 for (; I != E; ++I) { 11642 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I; 11643 11644 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam 11645 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the 11646 // candidate list. 11647 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) { 11648 break; 11649 } 11650 ++CandsShown; 11651 11652 if (Cand->Function) 11653 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size(), 11654 /*TakingCandidateAddress=*/false, DestAS); 11655 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 11656 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand); 11657 else { 11658 assert(Cand->Viable && 11659 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands."); 11660 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin 11661 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an 11662 // ambiguous user-defined conversion. 11663 // 11664 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see 11665 // different ambiguities, though. 11666 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) { 11667 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand); 11668 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true; 11669 } 11670 11671 // If this is a viable builtin, print it. 11672 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand); 11673 } 11674 } 11675 11676 if (I != E) 11677 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 11678 } 11679 11680 static SourceLocation 11681 GetLocationForCandidate(const TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand) { 11682 return Cand->Specialization ? Cand->Specialization->getLocation() 11683 : SourceLocation(); 11684 } 11685 11686 namespace { 11687 struct CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay { 11688 Sema &S; 11689 CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {} 11690 11691 bool operator()(const TemplateSpecCandidate *L, 11692 const TemplateSpecCandidate *R) { 11693 // Fast-path this check. 11694 if (L == R) 11695 return false; 11696 11697 // Assuming that both candidates are not matches... 11698 11699 // Sort by the ranking of deduction failures. 11700 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result) 11701 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) < 11702 RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure); 11703 11704 // Sort everything else by location. 11705 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L); 11706 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R); 11707 11708 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end. 11709 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) 11710 return false; 11711 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) 11712 return true; 11713 11714 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc); 11715 } 11716 }; 11717 } 11718 11719 /// Diagnose a template argument deduction failure. 11720 /// We are treating these failures as overload failures due to bad 11721 /// deductions. 11722 void TemplateSpecCandidate::NoteDeductionFailure(Sema &S, 11723 bool ForTakingAddress) { 11724 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, FoundDecl, Specialization, // pattern 11725 DeductionFailure, /*NumArgs=*/0, ForTakingAddress); 11726 } 11727 11728 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() { 11729 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) { 11730 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy(); 11731 } 11732 } 11733 11734 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::clear() { 11735 destroyCandidates(); 11736 Candidates.clear(); 11737 } 11738 11739 /// NoteCandidates - When no template specialization match is found, prints 11740 /// diagnostic messages containing the non-matching specializations that form 11741 /// the candidate set. 11742 /// This is analoguous to OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates() with 11743 /// OCD == OCD_AllCandidates and Cand->Viable == false. 11744 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) { 11745 // Sort the candidates by position (assuming no candidate is a match). 11746 // Sorting directly would be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers 11747 // and sort those. 11748 SmallVector<TemplateSpecCandidate *, 32> Cands; 11749 Cands.reserve(size()); 11750 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) { 11751 if (Cand->Specialization) 11752 Cands.push_back(Cand); 11753 // Otherwise, this is a non-matching builtin candidate. We do not, 11754 // in general, want to list every possible builtin candidate. 11755 } 11756 11757 llvm::sort(Cands, CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(S)); 11758 11759 // FIXME: Perhaps rename OverloadsShown and getShowOverloads() 11760 // for generalization purposes (?). 11761 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 11762 11763 SmallVectorImpl<TemplateSpecCandidate *>::iterator I, E; 11764 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 11765 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) { 11766 TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand = *I; 11767 11768 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidates we'll spam 11769 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the 11770 // candidate list. 11771 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) 11772 break; 11773 ++CandsShown; 11774 11775 assert(Cand->Specialization && 11776 "Non-matching built-in candidates are not added to Cands."); 11777 Cand->NoteDeductionFailure(S, ForTakingAddress); 11778 } 11779 11780 if (I != E) 11781 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 11782 } 11783 11784 // [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return] 11785 // NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType 11786 // R (A) --> R(A) 11787 // R (*)(A) --> R (A) 11788 // R (&)(A) --> R (A) 11789 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A) 11790 QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) { 11791 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType; 11792 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr = 11793 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>()) 11794 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 11795 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef = 11796 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 11797 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 11798 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr = 11799 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 11800 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 11801 Ret = 11802 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType(); 11803 return Ret; 11804 } 11805 11806 static bool completeFunctionType(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD, SourceLocation Loc, 11807 bool Complain = true) { 11808 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() && 11809 S.DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc, Complain)) 11810 return true; 11811 11812 auto *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 11813 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && 11814 isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType()) && 11815 !S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT)) 11816 return true; 11817 11818 return false; 11819 } 11820 11821 namespace { 11822 // A helper class to help with address of function resolution 11823 // - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters 11824 class AddressOfFunctionResolver { 11825 Sema& S; 11826 Expr* SourceExpr; 11827 const QualType& TargetType; 11828 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type 11829 11830 bool Complain; 11831 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair; 11832 ASTContext& Context; 11833 11834 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction; 11835 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction; 11836 bool StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer; 11837 bool HasComplained; 11838 11839 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo; 11840 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr; 11841 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs; 11842 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches; 11843 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates; 11844 11845 public: 11846 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr *SourceExpr, 11847 const QualType &TargetType, bool Complain) 11848 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType), 11849 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()), 11850 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction( 11851 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()), 11852 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false), 11853 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(false), 11854 HasComplained(false), 11855 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)), 11856 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression), 11857 FailedCandidates(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), /*ForTakingAddress=*/true) { 11858 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType(); 11859 11860 if (TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) { 11861 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *UME = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(OvlExpr)) 11862 if (!UME->isImplicitAccess() && 11863 !S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(UME)) 11864 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer = true; 11865 } else if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 11866 DeclAccessPair dap; 11867 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 11868 OvlExpr, false, &dap)) { 11869 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) 11870 if (!Method->isStatic()) { 11871 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function found 11872 // is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was the 11873 // target, it's the only possible type to end up with. 11874 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true; 11875 11876 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form. 11877 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions. 11878 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer) 11879 return; 11880 } 11881 11882 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap, Fn)); 11883 } 11884 return; 11885 } 11886 11887 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 11888 OvlExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs); 11889 11890 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) { 11891 // C++ [over.over]p4: 11892 // If more than one function is selected, [...] 11893 if (Matches.size() > 1 && !eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates()) { 11894 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction) 11895 EliminateAllTemplateMatches(); 11896 else 11897 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate(); 11898 } 11899 } 11900 11901 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Matches.size() > 1) 11902 EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches(); 11903 } 11904 11905 bool hasComplained() const { return HasComplained; } 11906 11907 private: 11908 bool candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 11909 QualType Discard; 11910 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType, FD->getType()) || 11911 S.IsFunctionConversion(FD->getType(), TargetFunctionType, Discard); 11912 } 11913 11914 /// \return true if A is considered a better overload candidate for the 11915 /// desired type than B. 11916 bool isBetterCandidate(const FunctionDecl *A, const FunctionDecl *B) { 11917 // If A doesn't have exactly the correct type, we don't want to classify it 11918 // as "better" than anything else. This way, the user is required to 11919 // disambiguate for us if there are multiple candidates and no exact match. 11920 return candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(A) && 11921 (!candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(B) || 11922 compareEnableIfAttrs(S, A, B) == Comparison::Better); 11923 } 11924 11925 /// \return true if we were able to eliminate all but one overload candidate, 11926 /// false otherwise. 11927 bool eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates() { 11928 // Same algorithm as overload resolution -- one pass to pick the "best", 11929 // another pass to be sure that nothing is better than the best. 11930 auto Best = Matches.begin(); 11931 for (auto I = Matches.begin()+1, E = Matches.end(); I != E; ++I) 11932 if (isBetterCandidate(I->second, Best->second)) 11933 Best = I; 11934 11935 const FunctionDecl *BestFn = Best->second; 11936 auto IsBestOrInferiorToBest = [this, BestFn]( 11937 const std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl *> &Pair) { 11938 return BestFn == Pair.second || isBetterCandidate(BestFn, Pair.second); 11939 }; 11940 11941 // Note: We explicitly leave Matches unmodified if there isn't a clear best 11942 // option, so we can potentially give the user a better error 11943 if (!llvm::all_of(Matches, IsBestOrInferiorToBest)) 11944 return false; 11945 Matches[0] = *Best; 11946 Matches.resize(1); 11947 return true; 11948 } 11949 11950 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const { 11951 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType(); 11952 } 11953 11954 // [ToType] [Return] 11955 11956 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false 11957 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false 11958 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true 11959 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() { 11960 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType); 11961 } 11962 11963 // return true if any matching specializations were found 11964 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate, 11965 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) { 11966 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method 11967 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) { 11968 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and 11969 // static when converting to member pointer. 11970 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 11971 return false; 11972 } 11973 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 11974 return false; 11975 11976 // C++ [over.over]p2: 11977 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 11978 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 11979 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 11980 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 11981 // overloaded functions considered. 11982 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 11983 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation()); 11984 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result 11985 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, 11986 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs, 11987 TargetFunctionType, Specialization, 11988 Info, /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) { 11989 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 11990 FailedCandidates.addCandidate() 11991 .set(CurAccessFunPair, FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(), 11992 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info)); 11993 return false; 11994 } 11995 11996 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match or 11997 // compatible pointer-to-function arguments that would be adjusted by ICS. 11998 // This function template specicalization works. 11999 assert(S.isSameOrCompatibleFunctionType( 12000 Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()), 12001 Context.getCanonicalType(TargetFunctionType))); 12002 12003 if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Specialization)) 12004 return false; 12005 12006 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization)); 12007 return true; 12008 } 12009 12010 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn, 12011 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) { 12012 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 12013 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static 12014 // when converting to member pointer. 12015 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 12016 return false; 12017 } 12018 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 12019 return false; 12020 12021 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) { 12022 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA) 12023 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext)) 12024 if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !S.IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, FunDecl)) 12025 return false; 12026 if (FunDecl->isMultiVersion()) { 12027 const auto *TA = FunDecl->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 12028 if (TA && !TA->isDefaultVersion()) 12029 return false; 12030 } 12031 12032 // If any candidate has a placeholder return type, trigger its deduction 12033 // now. 12034 if (completeFunctionType(S, FunDecl, SourceExpr->getBeginLoc(), 12035 Complain)) { 12036 HasComplained |= Complain; 12037 return false; 12038 } 12039 12040 if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FunDecl)) 12041 return false; 12042 12043 // If we're in C, we need to support types that aren't exactly identical. 12044 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || 12045 candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(FunDecl)) { 12046 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair( 12047 CurAccessFunPair, cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl()))); 12048 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true; 12049 return true; 12050 } 12051 } 12052 12053 return false; 12054 } 12055 12056 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() { 12057 bool Ret = false; 12058 12059 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to 12060 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type. 12061 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction()) 12062 return false; 12063 12064 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 12065 E = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 12066 I != E; ++I) { 12067 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function. 12068 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 12069 12070 // C++ [over.over]p3: 12071 // Non-member functions and static member functions match 12072 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function." 12073 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of 12074 // type "pointer-to-member-function." 12075 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter. 12076 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 12077 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) { 12078 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair())) 12079 Ret = true; 12080 } 12081 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates. 12082 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() && 12083 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair())) 12084 Ret = true; 12085 } 12086 assert(Ret || Matches.empty()); 12087 return Ret; 12088 } 12089 12090 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() { 12091 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is 12092 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template 12093 // specialization whose function template is more specialized 12094 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial 12095 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2. 12096 12097 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a 12098 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the 12099 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the 12100 // best function template (if it exists). 12101 12102 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid! 12103 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I) 12104 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess()); 12105 12106 // TODO: It looks like FailedCandidates does not serve much purpose 12107 // here, since the no_viable diagnostic has index 0. 12108 UnresolvedSetIterator Result = S.getMostSpecialized( 12109 MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(), FailedCandidates, 12110 SourceExpr->getBeginLoc(), S.PDiag(), 12111 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 12112 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(), 12113 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) 12114 << (unsigned)oc_function << (unsigned)ocs_described_template, 12115 Complain, TargetFunctionType); 12116 12117 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) { 12118 // Make it the first and only element 12119 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first; 12120 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result); 12121 Matches.resize(1); 12122 } else 12123 HasComplained |= Complain; 12124 } 12125 12126 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() { 12127 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are 12128 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...] 12129 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) { 12130 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == nullptr) 12131 ++I; 12132 else { 12133 Matches[I] = Matches[--N]; 12134 Matches.resize(N); 12135 } 12136 } 12137 } 12138 12139 void EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches() { 12140 S.EraseUnwantedCUDAMatches(dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext), Matches); 12141 } 12142 12143 public: 12144 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const { 12145 assert(Matches.empty()); 12146 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable) 12147 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType 12148 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 12149 if (FailedCandidates.empty()) 12150 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType, 12151 /*TakingAddress=*/true); 12152 else { 12153 // We have some deduction failure messages. Use them to diagnose 12154 // the function templates, and diagnose the non-template candidates 12155 // normally. 12156 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 12157 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 12158 I != IEnd; ++I) 12159 if (FunctionDecl *Fun = 12160 dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl())) 12161 if (!functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Fun)) 12162 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, CRK_None, TargetFunctionType, 12163 /*TakingAddress=*/true); 12164 FailedCandidates.NoteCandidates(S, OvlExpr->getBeginLoc()); 12165 } 12166 } 12167 12168 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const { 12169 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction && 12170 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer; 12171 } 12172 12173 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const { 12174 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might 12175 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers? 12176 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt. 12177 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier) 12178 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 12179 } 12180 12181 bool IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const { 12182 return StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer; 12183 } 12184 12185 void ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const { 12186 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), 12187 diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 12188 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 12189 } 12190 12191 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const { 12192 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref) 12193 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType; 12194 } 12195 12196 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const { 12197 assert(Matches.size() > 1); 12198 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 12199 << OvlExpr->getName() << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 12200 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType, 12201 /*TakingAddress=*/true); 12202 } 12203 12204 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); } 12205 12206 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); } 12207 12208 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const { 12209 if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr; 12210 return Matches[0].second; 12211 } 12212 12213 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const { 12214 if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr; 12215 return &Matches[0].first; 12216 } 12217 }; 12218 } 12219 12220 /// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of 12221 /// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an 12222 /// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type 12223 /// we're trying to resolve to. For example: 12224 /// 12225 /// @code 12226 /// int f(double); 12227 /// int f(int); 12228 /// 12229 /// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double) 12230 /// @endcode 12231 /// 12232 /// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be 12233 /// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this 12234 /// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error. 12235 FunctionDecl * 12236 Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr, 12237 QualType TargetType, 12238 bool Complain, 12239 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult, 12240 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) { 12241 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 12242 12243 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType, 12244 Complain); 12245 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches(); 12246 FunctionDecl *Fn = nullptr; 12247 bool ShouldComplain = Complain && !Resolver.hasComplained(); 12248 if (NumMatches == 0 && ShouldComplain) { 12249 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction()) 12250 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction(); 12251 else 12252 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound(); 12253 } 12254 else if (NumMatches > 1 && ShouldComplain) 12255 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound(); 12256 else if (NumMatches == 1) { 12257 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl(); 12258 assert(Fn); 12259 if (auto *FPT = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 12260 ResolveExceptionSpec(AddressOfExpr->getExprLoc(), FPT); 12261 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair(); 12262 if (Complain) { 12263 if (Resolver.IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer()) 12264 Resolver.ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(); 12265 else 12266 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult); 12267 } 12268 } 12269 12270 if (pHadMultipleCandidates) 12271 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates(); 12272 return Fn; 12273 } 12274 12275 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to 12276 /// resolve that function to a single function that can have its address taken. 12277 /// This will modify `Pair` iff it returns non-null. 12278 /// 12279 /// This routine can only succeed if from all of the candidates in the overload 12280 /// set for SrcExpr that can have their addresses taken, there is one candidate 12281 /// that is more constrained than the rest. 12282 FunctionDecl * 12283 Sema::resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair &Pair) { 12284 OverloadExpr::FindResult R = OverloadExpr::find(E); 12285 OverloadExpr *Ovl = R.Expression; 12286 bool IsResultAmbiguous = false; 12287 FunctionDecl *Result = nullptr; 12288 DeclAccessPair DAP; 12289 SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 2> AmbiguousDecls; 12290 12291 auto CheckMoreConstrained = 12292 [&] (FunctionDecl *FD1, FunctionDecl *FD2) -> Optional<bool> { 12293 SmallVector<const Expr *, 1> AC1, AC2; 12294 FD1->getAssociatedConstraints(AC1); 12295 FD2->getAssociatedConstraints(AC2); 12296 bool AtLeastAsConstrained1, AtLeastAsConstrained2; 12297 if (IsAtLeastAsConstrained(FD1, AC1, FD2, AC2, AtLeastAsConstrained1)) 12298 return None; 12299 if (IsAtLeastAsConstrained(FD2, AC2, FD1, AC1, AtLeastAsConstrained2)) 12300 return None; 12301 if (AtLeastAsConstrained1 == AtLeastAsConstrained2) 12302 return None; 12303 return AtLeastAsConstrained1; 12304 }; 12305 12306 // Don't use the AddressOfResolver because we're specifically looking for 12307 // cases where we have one overload candidate that lacks 12308 // enable_if/pass_object_size/... 12309 for (auto I = Ovl->decls_begin(), E = Ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 12310 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(I->getUnderlyingDecl()); 12311 if (!FD) 12312 return nullptr; 12313 12314 if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD)) 12315 continue; 12316 12317 // We have more than one result - see if it is more constrained than the 12318 // previous one. 12319 if (Result) { 12320 Optional<bool> MoreConstrainedThanPrevious = CheckMoreConstrained(FD, 12321 Result); 12322 if (!MoreConstrainedThanPrevious) { 12323 IsResultAmbiguous = true; 12324 AmbiguousDecls.push_back(FD); 12325 continue; 12326 } 12327 if (!*MoreConstrainedThanPrevious) 12328 continue; 12329 // FD is more constrained - replace Result with it. 12330 } 12331 IsResultAmbiguous = false; 12332 DAP = I.getPair(); 12333 Result = FD; 12334 } 12335 12336 if (IsResultAmbiguous) 12337 return nullptr; 12338 12339 if (Result) { 12340 SmallVector<const Expr *, 1> ResultAC; 12341 // We skipped over some ambiguous declarations which might be ambiguous with 12342 // the selected result. 12343 for (FunctionDecl *Skipped : AmbiguousDecls) 12344 if (!CheckMoreConstrained(Skipped, Result).hasValue()) 12345 return nullptr; 12346 Pair = DAP; 12347 } 12348 return Result; 12349 } 12350 12351 /// Given an overloaded function, tries to turn it into a non-overloaded 12352 /// function reference using resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate. This 12353 /// will perform access checks, diagnose the use of the resultant decl, and, if 12354 /// requested, potentially perform a function-to-pointer decay. 12355 /// 12356 /// Returns false if resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate fails. 12357 /// Otherwise, returns true. This may emit diagnostics and return true. 12358 bool Sema::resolveAndFixAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate( 12359 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool DoFunctionPointerConverion) { 12360 Expr *E = SrcExpr.get(); 12361 assert(E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy && "SrcExpr must be an overload"); 12362 12363 DeclAccessPair DAP; 12364 FunctionDecl *Found = resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(E, DAP); 12365 if (!Found || Found->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() || 12366 Found->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion()) 12367 return false; 12368 12369 // Emitting multiple diagnostics for a function that is both inaccessible and 12370 // unavailable is consistent with our behavior elsewhere. So, always check 12371 // for both. 12372 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Found, E->getExprLoc()); 12373 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(E, DAP); 12374 Expr *Fixed = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, DAP, Found); 12375 if (DoFunctionPointerConverion && Fixed->getType()->isFunctionType()) 12376 SrcExpr = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Fixed, /*Diagnose=*/false); 12377 else 12378 SrcExpr = Fixed; 12379 return true; 12380 } 12381 12382 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to 12383 /// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function. 12384 /// 12385 /// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function 12386 /// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template 12387 /// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults, 12388 /// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3. 12389 /// 12390 /// If no template-ids are found, no diagnostics are emitted and NULL is 12391 /// returned. 12392 FunctionDecl * 12393 Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl, 12394 bool Complain, 12395 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) { 12396 // C++ [over.over]p1: 12397 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the 12398 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ] 12399 // C++ [over.over]p1: 12400 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the & 12401 // operator. 12402 12403 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done. 12404 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 12405 return nullptr; 12406 12407 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs; 12408 ovl->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs); 12409 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates(ovl->getNameLoc()); 12410 12411 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one 12412 // whose type matches exactly. 12413 FunctionDecl *Matched = nullptr; 12414 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(), 12415 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 12416 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3: 12417 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts 12418 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is 12419 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments, 12420 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the 12421 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization. 12422 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 12423 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()); 12424 12425 // C++ [over.over]p2: 12426 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 12427 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 12428 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 12429 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 12430 // overloaded functions considered. 12431 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 12432 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation()); 12433 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 12434 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12435 Specialization, Info, 12436 /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) { 12437 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 12438 // TODO: Actually use the failed-deduction info? 12439 FailedCandidates.addCandidate() 12440 .set(I.getPair(), FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(), 12441 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info)); 12442 continue; 12443 } 12444 12445 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?"); 12446 12447 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration. 12448 if (Matched) { 12449 if (Complain) { 12450 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 12451 << ovl->getName(); 12452 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl); 12453 } 12454 return nullptr; 12455 } 12456 12457 Matched = Specialization; 12458 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair(); 12459 } 12460 12461 if (Matched && 12462 completeFunctionType(*this, Matched, ovl->getExprLoc(), Complain)) 12463 return nullptr; 12464 12465 return Matched; 12466 } 12467 12468 // Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved 12469 // because it identifies a single function template specialization. 12470 // 12471 // Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true 12472 // 12473 // Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the 12474 // expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always 12475 // returns true if 'complain' is set. 12476 bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 12477 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion, 12478 bool complain, SourceRange OpRangeForComplaining, 12479 QualType DestTypeForComplaining, 12480 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) { 12481 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 12482 12483 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get()); 12484 12485 DeclAccessPair found; 12486 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression; 12487 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 12488 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) { 12489 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getBeginLoc())) { 12490 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 12491 return true; 12492 } 12493 12494 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're 12495 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member. 12496 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which 12497 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this. 12498 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer && 12499 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) && 12500 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) { 12501 if (!complain) return false; 12502 12503 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(), 12504 diag::err_bound_member_function) 12505 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange(); 12506 12507 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of 12508 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression 12509 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type). 12510 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why 12511 // the static candidates were rejected. 12512 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 12513 return true; 12514 } 12515 12516 // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'. 12517 SingleFunctionExpression = 12518 FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.get(), found, fn); 12519 12520 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay. 12521 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) { 12522 SingleFunctionExpression = 12523 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.get()); 12524 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) { 12525 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 12526 return true; 12527 } 12528 } 12529 } 12530 12531 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) { 12532 if (complain) { 12533 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining) 12534 << ovl.Expression->getName() 12535 << DestTypeForComplaining 12536 << OpRangeForComplaining 12537 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange(); 12538 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get()); 12539 12540 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 12541 return true; 12542 } 12543 12544 return false; 12545 } 12546 12547 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression; 12548 return true; 12549 } 12550 12551 /// Add a single candidate to the overload set. 12552 static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S, 12553 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 12554 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12555 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 12556 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 12557 bool PartialOverloading, 12558 bool KnownValid) { 12559 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 12560 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)) 12561 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl(); 12562 12563 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) { 12564 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) { 12565 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?"); 12566 return; 12567 } 12568 // Prevent ill-formed function decls to be added as overload candidates. 12569 if (!dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>())) 12570 return; 12571 12572 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, 12573 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 12574 PartialOverloading); 12575 return; 12576 } 12577 12578 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate 12579 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) { 12580 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl, 12581 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet, 12582 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 12583 PartialOverloading); 12584 return; 12585 } 12586 12587 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate"); 12588 } 12589 12590 /// Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument 12591 /// dependent lookup to the given overload set. 12592 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 12593 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 12594 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 12595 bool PartialOverloading) { 12596 12597 #ifndef NDEBUG 12598 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules 12599 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 12600 // 12601 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1) 12602 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent 12603 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains 12604 // 12605 // -- a declaration of a class member, or 12606 // 12607 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a 12608 // using-declaration, or 12609 // 12610 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function 12611 // template 12612 // 12613 // then Y is empty. 12614 12615 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 12616 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 12617 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 12618 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord()); 12619 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) || 12620 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()); 12621 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate()); 12622 } 12623 } 12624 #endif 12625 12626 // It would be nice to avoid this copy. 12627 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 12628 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr; 12629 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 12630 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 12631 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 12632 } 12633 12634 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 12635 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) 12636 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 12637 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading, 12638 /*KnownValid*/ true); 12639 12640 if (ULE->requiresADL()) 12641 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), ULE->getExprLoc(), 12642 Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12643 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading); 12644 } 12645 12646 /// Determine whether a declaration with the specified name could be moved into 12647 /// a different namespace. 12648 static bool canBeDeclaredInNamespace(const DeclarationName &Name) { 12649 switch (Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator()) { 12650 case OO_New: case OO_Array_New: 12651 case OO_Delete: case OO_Array_Delete: 12652 return false; 12653 12654 default: 12655 return true; 12656 } 12657 } 12658 12659 /// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a 12660 /// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template 12661 /// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not 12662 /// correctly implement two-stage name lookup. 12663 /// 12664 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued. 12665 static bool 12666 DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc, 12667 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R, 12668 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK, 12669 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12670 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 12671 bool *DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = nullptr) { 12672 if (!SemaRef.inTemplateInstantiation() || !SS.isEmpty()) 12673 return false; 12674 12675 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) { 12676 if (DC->isTransparentContext()) 12677 continue; 12678 12679 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 12680 12681 if (!R.empty()) { 12682 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 12683 12684 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 12685 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better 12686 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup. 12687 R.clear(); 12688 if (DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup) 12689 *DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = true; 12690 return false; 12691 } 12692 12693 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc, CSK); 12694 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) 12695 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(), 12696 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 12697 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false); 12698 12699 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12700 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) { 12701 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions 12702 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway. 12703 R.clear(); 12704 return false; 12705 } 12706 12707 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest 12708 // declaring the function there instead. 12709 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces; 12710 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses; 12711 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args, 12712 AssociatedNamespaces, 12713 AssociatedClasses); 12714 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces; 12715 if (canBeDeclaredInNamespace(R.getLookupName())) { 12716 DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace(); 12717 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator 12718 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(), 12719 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) { 12720 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'. 12721 if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it)) 12722 continue; 12723 12724 // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a 12725 // reserved name, like __gnu_cxx. 12726 NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it); 12727 if (NS && 12728 NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos) 12729 continue; 12730 12731 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it); 12732 } 12733 } 12734 12735 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 12736 << R.getLookupName(); 12737 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) { 12738 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 12739 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 12740 << R.getLookupName() << 0; 12741 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) { 12742 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 12743 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 12744 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin(); 12745 } else { 12746 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here, 12747 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce 12748 // a localized representation of a list of items. 12749 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 12750 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 12751 << R.getLookupName() << 2; 12752 } 12753 12754 // Try to recover by calling this function. 12755 return true; 12756 } 12757 12758 R.clear(); 12759 } 12760 12761 return false; 12762 } 12763 12764 /// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a 12765 /// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template 12766 /// was defined. 12767 /// 12768 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued. 12769 static bool 12770 DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 12771 SourceLocation OpLoc, 12772 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 12773 DeclarationName OpName = 12774 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 12775 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName); 12776 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R, 12777 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator, 12778 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/nullptr, Args); 12779 } 12780 12781 namespace { 12782 class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII { 12783 Sema &SemaRef; 12784 public: 12785 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) { 12786 assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false); 12787 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true; 12788 } 12789 12790 ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() { 12791 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false; 12792 } 12793 }; 12794 12795 } 12796 12797 /// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found. 12798 static ExprResult 12799 BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 12800 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 12801 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 12802 MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 12803 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 12804 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 12805 // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call. 12806 // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like 12807 // 12808 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {} 12809 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {} 12810 // 12811 if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr) 12812 return ExprError(); 12813 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef); 12814 12815 CXXScopeSpec SS; 12816 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc()); 12817 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(); 12818 12819 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 12820 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr; 12821 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 12822 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 12823 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 12824 } 12825 12826 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(), 12827 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 12828 bool DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = EmptyLookup; 12829 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup( 12830 SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal, 12831 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, &DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup)) { 12832 NoTypoCorrectionCCC NoTypoValidator{}; 12833 FunctionCallFilterCCC FunctionCallValidator(SemaRef, Args.size(), 12834 ExplicitTemplateArgs != nullptr, 12835 dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn)); 12836 CorrectionCandidateCallback &Validator = 12837 AllowTypoCorrection 12838 ? static_cast<CorrectionCandidateCallback &>(FunctionCallValidator) 12839 : static_cast<CorrectionCandidateCallback &>(NoTypoValidator); 12840 if (!DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup || 12841 SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, Validator, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 12842 Args)) 12843 return ExprError(); 12844 } 12845 12846 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery"); 12847 12848 // If recovery created an ambiguity, just bail out. 12849 if (R.isAmbiguous()) { 12850 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 12851 return ExprError(); 12852 } 12853 12854 // Build an implicit member access expression if appropriate. Just drop the 12855 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care. 12856 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError(); 12857 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) 12858 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, 12859 ExplicitTemplateArgs, S); 12860 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid()) 12861 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false, 12862 ExplicitTemplateArgs); 12863 else 12864 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false); 12865 12866 if (NewFn.isInvalid()) 12867 return ExprError(); 12868 12869 auto CallE = 12870 SemaRef.BuildCallExpr(/*Scope*/ nullptr, NewFn.get(), LParenLoc, 12871 MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()), RParenLoc); 12872 if (CallE.isInvalid()) 12873 return ExprError(); 12874 // We now have recovered a callee. However, building a real call may lead to 12875 // incorrect secondary diagnostics if our recovery wasn't correct. 12876 // We keep the recovery behavior but suppress all following diagnostics by 12877 // using RecoveryExpr. We deliberately drop the return type of the recovery 12878 // function, and rely on clang's dependent mechanism to suppress following 12879 // diagnostics. 12880 return SemaRef.CreateRecoveryExpr(CallE.get()->getBeginLoc(), 12881 CallE.get()->getEndLoc(), {CallE.get()}); 12882 } 12883 12884 /// Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from 12885 /// the given function. 12886 /// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set. 12887 bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 12888 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 12889 MultiExprArg Args, 12890 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 12891 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 12892 ExprResult *Result) { 12893 #ifndef NDEBUG 12894 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 12895 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name. 12896 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL"); 12897 12898 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins. 12899 // Verify that this was correctly set up. 12900 FunctionDecl *F; 12901 if (ULE->decls_begin() != ULE->decls_end() && 12902 ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() && 12903 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) && 12904 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit()) 12905 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin"); 12906 12907 // We don't perform ADL in C. 12908 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C"); 12909 } 12910 #endif 12911 12912 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 12913 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) { 12914 *Result = ExprError(); 12915 return true; 12916 } 12917 12918 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate 12919 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup. 12920 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, *CandidateSet); 12921 12922 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 12923 CurContext->isDependentContext() && !isSFINAEContext() && 12924 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) { 12925 12926 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12927 if (CandidateSet->empty() || 12928 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best) == 12929 OR_No_Viable_Function) { 12930 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function 12931 // then create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name 12932 // lookup to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent 12933 // base classes. 12934 CallExpr *CE = 12935 CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, 12936 RParenLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 12937 CE->markDependentForPostponedNameLookup(); 12938 *Result = CE; 12939 return true; 12940 } 12941 } 12942 12943 if (CandidateSet->empty()) 12944 return false; 12945 12946 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 12947 return false; 12948 } 12949 12950 // Guess at what the return type for an unresolvable overload should be. 12951 static QualType chooseRecoveryType(OverloadCandidateSet &CS, 12952 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best) { 12953 llvm::Optional<QualType> Result; 12954 // Adjust Type after seeing a candidate. 12955 auto ConsiderCandidate = [&](const OverloadCandidate &Candidate) { 12956 if (!Candidate.Function) 12957 return; 12958 if (Candidate.Function->isInvalidDecl()) 12959 return; 12960 QualType T = Candidate.Function->getReturnType(); 12961 if (T.isNull()) 12962 return; 12963 if (!Result) 12964 Result = T; 12965 else if (Result != T) 12966 Result = QualType(); 12967 }; 12968 12969 // Look for an unambiguous type from a progressively larger subset. 12970 // e.g. if types disagree, but all *viable* overloads return int, choose int. 12971 // 12972 // First, consider only the best candidate. 12973 if (Best && *Best != CS.end()) 12974 ConsiderCandidate(**Best); 12975 // Next, consider only viable candidates. 12976 if (!Result) 12977 for (const auto &C : CS) 12978 if (C.Viable) 12979 ConsiderCandidate(C); 12980 // Finally, consider all candidates. 12981 if (!Result) 12982 for (const auto &C : CS) 12983 ConsiderCandidate(C); 12984 12985 if (!Result) 12986 return QualType(); 12987 auto Value = Result.getValue(); 12988 if (Value.isNull() || Value->isUndeducedType()) 12989 return QualType(); 12990 return Value; 12991 } 12992 12993 /// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns 12994 /// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits 12995 /// diagnostics and returns ExprError() 12996 static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 12997 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 12998 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 12999 MultiExprArg Args, 13000 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 13001 Expr *ExecConfig, 13002 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 13003 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best, 13004 OverloadingResult OverloadResult, 13005 bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 13006 if (CandidateSet->empty()) 13007 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, 13008 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true, 13009 AllowTypoCorrection); 13010 13011 switch (OverloadResult) { 13012 case OR_Success: { 13013 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function; 13014 SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl); 13015 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc())) 13016 return ExprError(); 13017 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl); 13018 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc, 13019 ExecConfig, /*IsExecConfig=*/false, 13020 (*Best)->IsADLCandidate); 13021 } 13022 13023 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 13024 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might 13025 // have meant to call. 13026 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, 13027 Args, RParenLoc, 13028 /*EmptyLookup=*/false, 13029 AllowTypoCorrection); 13030 if (!Recovery.isInvalid()) 13031 return Recovery; 13032 13033 // If the user passes in a function that we can't take the address of, we 13034 // generally end up emitting really bad error messages. Here, we attempt to 13035 // emit better ones. 13036 for (const Expr *Arg : Args) { 13037 if (!Arg->getType()->isFunctionType()) 13038 continue; 13039 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts())) { 13040 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 13041 if (FD && 13042 !SemaRef.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, /*Complain=*/true, 13043 Arg->getExprLoc())) 13044 return ExprError(); 13045 } 13046 } 13047 13048 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates( 13049 PartialDiagnosticAt( 13050 Fn->getBeginLoc(), 13051 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 13052 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()), 13053 SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 13054 break; 13055 } 13056 13057 case OR_Ambiguous: 13058 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates( 13059 PartialDiagnosticAt(Fn->getBeginLoc(), 13060 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) 13061 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()), 13062 SemaRef, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args); 13063 break; 13064 13065 case OR_Deleted: { 13066 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates( 13067 PartialDiagnosticAt(Fn->getBeginLoc(), 13068 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_call) 13069 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()), 13070 SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 13071 13072 // We emitted an error for the unavailable/deleted function call but keep 13073 // the call in the AST. 13074 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function; 13075 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl); 13076 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc, 13077 ExecConfig, /*IsExecConfig=*/false, 13078 (*Best)->IsADLCandidate); 13079 } 13080 } 13081 13082 // Overload resolution failed, try to recover. 13083 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> SubExprs = {Fn}; 13084 SubExprs.append(Args.begin(), Args.end()); 13085 return SemaRef.CreateRecoveryExpr(Fn->getBeginLoc(), RParenLoc, SubExprs, 13086 chooseRecoveryType(*CandidateSet, Best)); 13087 } 13088 13089 static void markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(Sema &S, 13090 OverloadCandidateSet &CS) { 13091 for (auto I = CS.begin(), E = CS.end(); I != E; ++I) { 13092 if (I->Viable && 13093 !S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(I->Function, /*Complain=*/false)) { 13094 I->Viable = false; 13095 I->FailureKind = ovl_fail_addr_not_available; 13096 } 13097 } 13098 } 13099 13100 /// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn 13101 /// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call 13102 /// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down 13103 /// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns 13104 /// the call expression produced by overload resolution. 13105 /// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError. 13106 ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 13107 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 13108 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 13109 MultiExprArg Args, 13110 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 13111 Expr *ExecConfig, 13112 bool AllowTypoCorrection, 13113 bool CalleesAddressIsTaken) { 13114 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc(), 13115 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 13116 ExprResult result; 13117 13118 if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, LParenLoc, &CandidateSet, 13119 &result)) 13120 return result; 13121 13122 // If the user handed us something like `(&Foo)(Bar)`, we need to ensure that 13123 // functions that aren't addressible are considered unviable. 13124 if (CalleesAddressIsTaken) 13125 markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(*this, CandidateSet); 13126 13127 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13128 OverloadingResult OverloadResult = 13129 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best); 13130 13131 return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc, 13132 ExecConfig, &CandidateSet, &Best, 13133 OverloadResult, AllowTypoCorrection); 13134 } 13135 13136 static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) { 13137 return Functions.size() > 1 || 13138 (Functions.size() == 1 && 13139 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*Functions.begin())->getUnderlyingDecl())); 13140 } 13141 13142 ExprResult Sema::CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass, 13143 NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNSLoc, 13144 DeclarationNameInfo DNI, 13145 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 13146 bool PerformADL) { 13147 return UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, NNSLoc, DNI, 13148 PerformADL, IsOverloaded(Fns), 13149 Fns.begin(), Fns.end()); 13150 } 13151 13152 /// Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 13153 /// operator. 13154 /// 13155 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*'). 13156 /// 13157 /// \param Opc The UnaryOperatorKind that describes this operator. 13158 /// 13159 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be 13160 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 13161 /// set based on the context using, e.g., 13162 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 13163 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 13164 /// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(). 13165 /// 13166 /// \param Input The input argument. 13167 ExprResult 13168 Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, UnaryOperatorKind Opc, 13169 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 13170 Expr *Input, bool PerformADL) { 13171 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 13172 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator"); 13173 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 13174 // TODO: provide better source location info. 13175 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 13176 13177 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input)) 13178 return ExprError(); 13179 13180 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, nullptr }; 13181 unsigned NumArgs = 1; 13182 13183 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as 13184 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or 13185 // post-decrement. 13186 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) { 13187 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false); 13188 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, 13189 SourceLocation()); 13190 NumArgs = 2; 13191 } 13192 13193 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, NumArgs); 13194 13195 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) { 13196 if (Fns.empty()) 13197 return UnaryOperator::Create(Context, Input, Opc, Context.DependentTy, 13198 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, OpLoc, false, 13199 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13200 13201 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 13202 ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr( 13203 NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, Fns); 13204 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 13205 return ExprError(); 13206 return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, Op, Fn.get(), ArgsArray, 13207 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OpLoc, 13208 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13209 } 13210 13211 // Build an empty overload set. 13212 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 13213 13214 // Add the candidates from the given function set. 13215 AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(Fns, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 13216 13217 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 13218 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 13219 13220 // Add candidates from ADL. 13221 if (PerformADL) { 13222 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, ArgsArray, 13223 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/nullptr, 13224 CandidateSet); 13225 } 13226 13227 // Add builtin operator candidates. 13228 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 13229 13230 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 13231 13232 // Perform overload resolution. 13233 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13234 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 13235 case OR_Success: { 13236 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 13237 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 13238 13239 if (FnDecl) { 13240 Expr *Base = nullptr; 13241 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 13242 // operator. 13243 13244 // Convert the arguments. 13245 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 13246 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 13247 13248 ExprResult InputRes = 13249 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 13250 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 13251 if (InputRes.isInvalid()) 13252 return ExprError(); 13253 Base = Input = InputRes.get(); 13254 } else { 13255 // Convert the arguments. 13256 ExprResult InputInit 13257 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 13258 Context, 13259 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 13260 SourceLocation(), 13261 Input); 13262 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 13263 return ExprError(); 13264 Input = InputInit.get(); 13265 } 13266 13267 // Build the actual expression node. 13268 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl, 13269 Base, HadMultipleCandidates, 13270 OpLoc); 13271 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 13272 return ExprError(); 13273 13274 // Determine the result type. 13275 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 13276 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 13277 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 13278 13279 Args[0] = Input; 13280 CallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create( 13281 Context, Op, FnExpr.get(), ArgsArray, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, 13282 CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Best->IsADLCandidate); 13283 13284 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, FnDecl)) 13285 return ExprError(); 13286 13287 if (CheckFunctionCall(FnDecl, TheCall, 13288 FnDecl->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>())) 13289 return ExprError(); 13290 return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall), FnDecl); 13291 } else { 13292 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 13293 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 13294 // operator node. 13295 ExprResult InputRes = PerformImplicitConversion( 13296 Input, Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing, 13297 CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 13298 if (InputRes.isInvalid()) 13299 return ExprError(); 13300 Input = InputRes.get(); 13301 break; 13302 } 13303 } 13304 13305 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 13306 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by 13307 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were 13308 // defined too late to be candidates. 13309 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray)) 13310 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function. 13311 return ExprError(); 13312 13313 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a 13314 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us. 13315 break; 13316 13317 case OR_Ambiguous: 13318 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13319 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, 13320 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 13321 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13322 << Input->getType() << Input->getSourceRange()), 13323 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, ArgsArray, 13324 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 13325 return ExprError(); 13326 13327 case OR_Deleted: 13328 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13329 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 13330 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13331 << Input->getSourceRange()), 13332 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, ArgsArray, UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), 13333 OpLoc); 13334 return ExprError(); 13335 } 13336 13337 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a 13338 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to 13339 // build a built-in operation. 13340 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 13341 } 13342 13343 /// Perform lookup for an overloaded binary operator. 13344 void Sema::LookupOverloadedBinOp(OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 13345 OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 13346 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 13347 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, bool PerformADL) { 13348 SourceLocation OpLoc = CandidateSet.getLocation(); 13349 13350 OverloadedOperatorKind ExtraOp = 13351 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().AllowRewrittenCandidates 13352 ? getRewrittenOverloadedOperator(Op) 13353 : OO_None; 13354 13355 // Add the candidates from the given function set. This also adds the 13356 // rewritten candidates using these functions if necessary. 13357 AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet); 13358 13359 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 13360 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 13361 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Op)) 13362 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, {Args[1], Args[0]}, CandidateSet, 13363 OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 13364 13365 // In C++20, also add any rewritten member candidates. 13366 if (ExtraOp) { 13367 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(ExtraOp, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 13368 if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(ExtraOp)) 13369 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(ExtraOp, OpLoc, {Args[1], Args[0]}, 13370 CandidateSet, 13371 OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed); 13372 } 13373 13374 // Add candidates from ADL. Per [over.match.oper]p2, this lookup is not 13375 // performed for an assignment operator (nor for operator[] nor operator->, 13376 // which don't get here). 13377 if (Op != OO_Equal && PerformADL) { 13378 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 13379 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, Args, 13380 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr, 13381 CandidateSet); 13382 if (ExtraOp) { 13383 DeclarationName ExtraOpName = 13384 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(ExtraOp); 13385 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ExtraOpName, OpLoc, Args, 13386 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr, 13387 CandidateSet); 13388 } 13389 } 13390 13391 // Add builtin operator candidates. 13392 // 13393 // FIXME: We don't add any rewritten candidates here. This is strictly 13394 // incorrect; a builtin candidate could be hidden by a non-viable candidate, 13395 // resulting in our selecting a rewritten builtin candidate. For example: 13396 // 13397 // enum class E { e }; 13398 // bool operator!=(E, E) requires false; 13399 // bool k = E::e != E::e; 13400 // 13401 // ... should select the rewritten builtin candidate 'operator==(E, E)'. But 13402 // it seems unreasonable to consider rewritten builtin candidates. A core 13403 // issue has been filed proposing to removed this requirement. 13404 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 13405 } 13406 13407 /// Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 13408 /// operator. 13409 /// 13410 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+'). 13411 /// 13412 /// \param Opc The BinaryOperatorKind that describes this operator. 13413 /// 13414 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be 13415 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 13416 /// set based on the context using, e.g., 13417 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 13418 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 13419 /// by CreateOverloadedBinOp(). 13420 /// 13421 /// \param LHS Left-hand argument. 13422 /// \param RHS Right-hand argument. 13423 /// \param PerformADL Whether to consider operator candidates found by ADL. 13424 /// \param AllowRewrittenCandidates Whether to consider candidates found by 13425 /// C++20 operator rewrites. 13426 /// \param DefaultedFn If we are synthesizing a defaulted operator function, 13427 /// the function in question. Such a function is never a candidate in 13428 /// our overload resolution. This also enables synthesizing a three-way 13429 /// comparison from < and == as described in C++20 [class.spaceship]p1. 13430 ExprResult Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 13431 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 13432 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *LHS, 13433 Expr *RHS, bool PerformADL, 13434 bool AllowRewrittenCandidates, 13435 FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn) { 13436 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS }; 13437 LHS=RHS=nullptr; // Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple 13438 13439 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20) 13440 AllowRewrittenCandidates = false; 13441 13442 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 13443 13444 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 13445 // expression. 13446 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 13447 if (Fns.empty()) { 13448 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent 13449 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment. 13450 if (BinaryOperator::isCompoundAssignmentOp(Opc)) 13451 return CompoundAssignOperator::Create( 13452 Context, Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_LValue, 13453 OK_Ordinary, OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Context.DependentTy, 13454 Context.DependentTy); 13455 return BinaryOperator::Create(Context, Args[0], Args[1], Opc, 13456 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 13457 OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13458 } 13459 13460 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here? 13461 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 13462 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component. 13463 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 13464 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 13465 ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr( 13466 NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, Fns, PerformADL); 13467 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 13468 return ExprError(); 13469 return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, Op, Fn.get(), Args, 13470 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OpLoc, 13471 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13472 } 13473 13474 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS. 13475 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1])) 13476 return ExprError(); 13477 13478 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should 13479 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS. 13480 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty); 13481 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0])) 13482 return ExprError(); 13483 13484 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution 13485 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually 13486 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the 13487 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to 13488 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does. 13489 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms. 13490 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 13491 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 13492 13493 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just 13494 // create a built-in binary operator. 13495 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD) 13496 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 13497 13498 // Build the overload set. 13499 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet( 13500 OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator, 13501 OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo(Op, AllowRewrittenCandidates)); 13502 if (DefaultedFn) 13503 CandidateSet.exclude(DefaultedFn); 13504 LookupOverloadedBinOp(CandidateSet, Op, Fns, Args, PerformADL); 13505 13506 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 13507 13508 // Perform overload resolution. 13509 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13510 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 13511 case OR_Success: { 13512 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 13513 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 13514 13515 bool IsReversed = Best->isReversed(); 13516 if (IsReversed) 13517 std::swap(Args[0], Args[1]); 13518 13519 if (FnDecl) { 13520 Expr *Base = nullptr; 13521 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 13522 // operator. 13523 13524 OverloadedOperatorKind ChosenOp = 13525 FnDecl->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator(); 13526 13527 // C++2a [over.match.oper]p9: 13528 // If a rewritten operator== candidate is selected by overload 13529 // resolution for an operator@, its return type shall be cv bool 13530 if (Best->RewriteKind && ChosenOp == OO_EqualEqual && 13531 !FnDecl->getReturnType()->isBooleanType()) { 13532 bool IsExtension = 13533 FnDecl->getReturnType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType(); 13534 Diag(OpLoc, IsExtension ? diag::ext_ovl_rewrite_equalequal_not_bool 13535 : diag::err_ovl_rewrite_equalequal_not_bool) 13536 << FnDecl->getReturnType() << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13537 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 13538 Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 13539 if (!IsExtension) 13540 return ExprError(); 13541 } 13542 13543 if (AllowRewrittenCandidates && !IsReversed && 13544 CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().isReversible()) { 13545 // We could have reversed this operator, but didn't. Check if some 13546 // reversed form was a viable candidate, and if so, if it had a 13547 // better conversion for either parameter. If so, this call is 13548 // formally ambiguous, and allowing it is an extension. 13549 llvm::SmallVector<FunctionDecl*, 4> AmbiguousWith; 13550 for (OverloadCandidate &Cand : CandidateSet) { 13551 if (Cand.Viable && Cand.Function && Cand.isReversed() && 13552 haveSameParameterTypes(Context, Cand.Function, FnDecl, 2)) { 13553 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 13554 if (CompareImplicitConversionSequences( 13555 *this, OpLoc, Cand.Conversions[ArgIdx], 13556 Best->Conversions[ArgIdx]) == 13557 ImplicitConversionSequence::Better) { 13558 AmbiguousWith.push_back(Cand.Function); 13559 break; 13560 } 13561 } 13562 } 13563 } 13564 13565 if (!AmbiguousWith.empty()) { 13566 bool AmbiguousWithSelf = 13567 AmbiguousWith.size() == 1 && 13568 declaresSameEntity(AmbiguousWith.front(), FnDecl); 13569 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed) 13570 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13571 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType() << AmbiguousWithSelf 13572 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 13573 if (AmbiguousWithSelf) { 13574 Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(), 13575 diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed_self); 13576 } else { 13577 Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(), 13578 diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_selected_candidate); 13579 for (auto *F : AmbiguousWith) 13580 Diag(F->getLocation(), 13581 diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed_candidate); 13582 } 13583 } 13584 } 13585 13586 // Convert the arguments. 13587 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 13588 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members. 13589 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 13590 13591 ExprResult Arg1 = 13592 PerformCopyInitialization( 13593 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 13594 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 13595 SourceLocation(), Args[1]); 13596 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 13597 return ExprError(); 13598 13599 ExprResult Arg0 = 13600 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 13601 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 13602 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 13603 return ExprError(); 13604 Base = Args[0] = Arg0.getAs<Expr>(); 13605 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>(); 13606 } else { 13607 // Convert the arguments. 13608 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization( 13609 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 13610 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 13611 SourceLocation(), Args[0]); 13612 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 13613 return ExprError(); 13614 13615 ExprResult Arg1 = 13616 PerformCopyInitialization( 13617 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 13618 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)), 13619 SourceLocation(), Args[1]); 13620 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 13621 return ExprError(); 13622 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.getAs<Expr>(); 13623 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>(); 13624 } 13625 13626 // Build the actual expression node. 13627 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 13628 Best->FoundDecl, Base, 13629 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 13630 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 13631 return ExprError(); 13632 13633 // Determine the result type. 13634 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 13635 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 13636 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 13637 13638 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create( 13639 Context, ChosenOp, FnExpr.get(), Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, 13640 CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Best->IsADLCandidate); 13641 13642 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, 13643 FnDecl)) 13644 return ExprError(); 13645 13646 ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2); 13647 const Expr *ImplicitThis = nullptr; 13648 // Cut off the implicit 'this'. 13649 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 13650 ImplicitThis = ArgsArray[0]; 13651 ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1); 13652 } 13653 13654 // Check for a self move. 13655 if (Op == OO_Equal) 13656 DiagnoseSelfMove(Args[0], Args[1], OpLoc); 13657 13658 checkCall(FnDecl, nullptr, ImplicitThis, ArgsArray, 13659 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc, TheCall->getSourceRange(), 13660 VariadicDoesNotApply); 13661 13662 ExprResult R = MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 13663 if (R.isInvalid()) 13664 return ExprError(); 13665 13666 R = CheckForImmediateInvocation(R, FnDecl); 13667 if (R.isInvalid()) 13668 return ExprError(); 13669 13670 // For a rewritten candidate, we've already reversed the arguments 13671 // if needed. Perform the rest of the rewrite now. 13672 if ((Best->RewriteKind & CRK_DifferentOperator) || 13673 (Op == OO_Spaceship && IsReversed)) { 13674 if (Op == OO_ExclaimEqual) { 13675 assert(ChosenOp == OO_EqualEqual && "unexpected operator name"); 13676 R = CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, UO_LNot, R.get()); 13677 } else { 13678 assert(ChosenOp == OO_Spaceship && "unexpected operator name"); 13679 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false); 13680 Expr *ZeroLiteral = 13681 IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, OpLoc); 13682 13683 Sema::CodeSynthesisContext Ctx; 13684 Ctx.Kind = Sema::CodeSynthesisContext::RewritingOperatorAsSpaceship; 13685 Ctx.Entity = FnDecl; 13686 pushCodeSynthesisContext(Ctx); 13687 13688 R = CreateOverloadedBinOp( 13689 OpLoc, Opc, Fns, IsReversed ? ZeroLiteral : R.get(), 13690 IsReversed ? R.get() : ZeroLiteral, PerformADL, 13691 /*AllowRewrittenCandidates=*/false); 13692 13693 popCodeSynthesisContext(); 13694 } 13695 if (R.isInvalid()) 13696 return ExprError(); 13697 } else { 13698 assert(ChosenOp == Op && "unexpected operator name"); 13699 } 13700 13701 // Make a note in the AST if we did any rewriting. 13702 if (Best->RewriteKind != CRK_None) 13703 R = new (Context) CXXRewrittenBinaryOperator(R.get(), IsReversed); 13704 13705 return R; 13706 } else { 13707 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 13708 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 13709 // operator node. 13710 ExprResult ArgsRes0 = PerformImplicitConversion( 13711 Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], 13712 AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 13713 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid()) 13714 return ExprError(); 13715 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get(); 13716 13717 ExprResult ArgsRes1 = PerformImplicitConversion( 13718 Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], Best->Conversions[1], 13719 AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 13720 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid()) 13721 return ExprError(); 13722 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get(); 13723 break; 13724 } 13725 } 13726 13727 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 13728 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9: 13729 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no 13730 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the 13731 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5. 13732 if (Opc == BO_Comma) 13733 break; 13734 13735 // When defaulting an 'operator<=>', we can try to synthesize a three-way 13736 // compare result using '==' and '<'. 13737 if (DefaultedFn && Opc == BO_Cmp) { 13738 ExprResult E = BuildSynthesizedThreeWayComparison(OpLoc, Fns, Args[0], 13739 Args[1], DefaultedFn); 13740 if (E.isInvalid() || E.isUsable()) 13741 return E; 13742 } 13743 13744 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assignment 13745 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that 13746 // no overloaded assignment operator found 13747 ExprResult Result = ExprError(); 13748 StringRef OpcStr = BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc); 13749 auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, 13750 Args, OpLoc); 13751 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() && 13752 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) { 13753 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 13754 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13755 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 13756 if (Args[0]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) { 13757 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_assign_lhs_incomplete) 13758 << Args[0]->getType() 13759 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 13760 } 13761 } else { 13762 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by 13763 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were 13764 // defined too late to be candidates. 13765 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args)) 13766 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function. 13767 return ExprError(); 13768 13769 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will 13770 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates. 13771 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 13772 } 13773 assert(Result.isInvalid() && 13774 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!"); 13775 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, Args, Cands, OpcStr, OpLoc); 13776 return Result; 13777 } 13778 13779 case OR_Ambiguous: 13780 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13781 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 13782 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 13783 << Args[0]->getType() 13784 << Args[1]->getType() 13785 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 13786 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()), 13787 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args, BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), 13788 OpLoc); 13789 return ExprError(); 13790 13791 case OR_Deleted: 13792 if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) { 13793 FunctionDecl *DeletedFD = Best->Function; 13794 DefaultedFunctionKind DFK = getDefaultedFunctionKind(DeletedFD); 13795 if (DFK.isSpecialMember()) { 13796 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper) 13797 << Args[0]->getType() << DFK.asSpecialMember(); 13798 } else { 13799 assert(DFK.isComparison()); 13800 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_comparison) 13801 << Args[0]->getType() << DeletedFD; 13802 } 13803 13804 // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just 13805 // explain why it's deleted. 13806 NoteDeletedFunction(DeletedFD); 13807 return ExprError(); 13808 } 13809 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 13810 PartialDiagnosticAt( 13811 OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 13812 << getOperatorSpelling(Best->Function->getDeclName() 13813 .getCXXOverloadedOperator()) 13814 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 13815 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()), 13816 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), 13817 OpLoc); 13818 return ExprError(); 13819 } 13820 13821 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 13822 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 13823 } 13824 13825 ExprResult Sema::BuildSynthesizedThreeWayComparison( 13826 SourceLocation OpLoc, const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS, 13827 FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn) { 13828 const ComparisonCategoryInfo *Info = 13829 Context.CompCategories.lookupInfoForType(DefaultedFn->getReturnType()); 13830 // If we're not producing a known comparison category type, we can't 13831 // synthesize a three-way comparison. Let the caller diagnose this. 13832 if (!Info) 13833 return ExprResult((Expr*)nullptr); 13834 13835 // If we ever want to perform this synthesis more generally, we will need to 13836 // apply the temporary materialization conversion to the operands. 13837 assert(LHS->isGLValue() && RHS->isGLValue() && 13838 "cannot use prvalue expressions more than once"); 13839 Expr *OrigLHS = LHS; 13840 Expr *OrigRHS = RHS; 13841 13842 // Replace the LHS and RHS with OpaqueValueExprs; we're going to refer to 13843 // each of them multiple times below. 13844 LHS = new (Context) 13845 OpaqueValueExpr(LHS->getExprLoc(), LHS->getType(), LHS->getValueKind(), 13846 LHS->getObjectKind(), LHS); 13847 RHS = new (Context) 13848 OpaqueValueExpr(RHS->getExprLoc(), RHS->getType(), RHS->getValueKind(), 13849 RHS->getObjectKind(), RHS); 13850 13851 ExprResult Eq = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_EQ, Fns, LHS, RHS, true, true, 13852 DefaultedFn); 13853 if (Eq.isInvalid()) 13854 return ExprError(); 13855 13856 ExprResult Less = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_LT, Fns, LHS, RHS, true, 13857 true, DefaultedFn); 13858 if (Less.isInvalid()) 13859 return ExprError(); 13860 13861 ExprResult Greater; 13862 if (Info->isPartial()) { 13863 Greater = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_LT, Fns, RHS, LHS, true, true, 13864 DefaultedFn); 13865 if (Greater.isInvalid()) 13866 return ExprError(); 13867 } 13868 13869 // Form the list of comparisons we're going to perform. 13870 struct Comparison { 13871 ExprResult Cmp; 13872 ComparisonCategoryResult Result; 13873 } Comparisons[4] = 13874 { {Eq, Info->isStrong() ? ComparisonCategoryResult::Equal 13875 : ComparisonCategoryResult::Equivalent}, 13876 {Less, ComparisonCategoryResult::Less}, 13877 {Greater, ComparisonCategoryResult::Greater}, 13878 {ExprResult(), ComparisonCategoryResult::Unordered}, 13879 }; 13880 13881 int I = Info->isPartial() ? 3 : 2; 13882 13883 // Combine the comparisons with suitable conditional expressions. 13884 ExprResult Result; 13885 for (; I >= 0; --I) { 13886 // Build a reference to the comparison category constant. 13887 auto *VI = Info->lookupValueInfo(Comparisons[I].Result); 13888 // FIXME: Missing a constant for a comparison category. Diagnose this? 13889 if (!VI) 13890 return ExprResult((Expr*)nullptr); 13891 ExprResult ThisResult = 13892 BuildDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec(), DeclarationNameInfo(), VI->VD); 13893 if (ThisResult.isInvalid()) 13894 return ExprError(); 13895 13896 // Build a conditional unless this is the final case. 13897 if (Result.get()) { 13898 Result = ActOnConditionalOp(OpLoc, OpLoc, Comparisons[I].Cmp.get(), 13899 ThisResult.get(), Result.get()); 13900 if (Result.isInvalid()) 13901 return ExprError(); 13902 } else { 13903 Result = ThisResult; 13904 } 13905 } 13906 13907 // Build a PseudoObjectExpr to model the rewriting of an <=> operator, and to 13908 // bind the OpaqueValueExprs before they're (repeatedly) used. 13909 Expr *SyntacticForm = BinaryOperator::Create( 13910 Context, OrigLHS, OrigRHS, BO_Cmp, Result.get()->getType(), 13911 Result.get()->getValueKind(), Result.get()->getObjectKind(), OpLoc, 13912 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13913 Expr *SemanticForm[] = {LHS, RHS, Result.get()}; 13914 return PseudoObjectExpr::Create(Context, SyntacticForm, SemanticForm, 2); 13915 } 13916 13917 ExprResult 13918 Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc, 13919 SourceLocation RLoc, 13920 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) { 13921 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx }; 13922 DeclarationName OpName = 13923 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript); 13924 13925 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 13926 // expression. 13927 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 13928 13929 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 13930 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword? 13931 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc); 13932 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc)); 13933 ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr( 13934 NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, UnresolvedSet<0>()); 13935 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 13936 return ExprError(); 13937 // Can't add any actual overloads yet 13938 13939 return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn.get(), Args, 13940 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RLoc, 13941 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 13942 } 13943 13944 // Handle placeholders on both operands. 13945 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0])) 13946 return ExprError(); 13947 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1])) 13948 return ExprError(); 13949 13950 // Build an empty overload set. 13951 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 13952 13953 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function. 13954 13955 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 13956 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 13957 13958 // Add builtin operator candidates. 13959 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 13960 13961 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 13962 13963 // Perform overload resolution. 13964 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13965 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) { 13966 case OR_Success: { 13967 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 13968 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 13969 13970 if (FnDecl) { 13971 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 13972 // operator. 13973 13974 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 13975 13976 // Convert the arguments. 13977 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl); 13978 ExprResult Arg0 = 13979 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 13980 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 13981 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 13982 return ExprError(); 13983 Args[0] = Arg0.get(); 13984 13985 // Convert the arguments. 13986 ExprResult InputInit 13987 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 13988 Context, 13989 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 13990 SourceLocation(), 13991 Args[1]); 13992 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 13993 return ExprError(); 13994 13995 Args[1] = InputInit.getAs<Expr>(); 13996 13997 // Build the actual expression node. 13998 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc); 13999 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc)); 14000 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 14001 Best->FoundDecl, 14002 Base, 14003 HadMultipleCandidates, 14004 OpLocInfo.getLoc(), 14005 OpLocInfo.getInfo()); 14006 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 14007 return ExprError(); 14008 14009 // Determine the result type 14010 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 14011 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 14012 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14013 14014 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create( 14015 Context, OO_Subscript, FnExpr.get(), Args, ResultTy, VK, RLoc, 14016 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14017 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), LLoc, TheCall, FnDecl)) 14018 return ExprError(); 14019 14020 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, 14021 Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>())) 14022 return ExprError(); 14023 14024 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 14025 } else { 14026 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 14027 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 14028 // operator node. 14029 ExprResult ArgsRes0 = PerformImplicitConversion( 14030 Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], 14031 AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 14032 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid()) 14033 return ExprError(); 14034 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get(); 14035 14036 ExprResult ArgsRes1 = PerformImplicitConversion( 14037 Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], Best->Conversions[1], 14038 AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp); 14039 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid()) 14040 return ExprError(); 14041 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get(); 14042 14043 break; 14044 } 14045 } 14046 14047 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 14048 PartialDiagnostic PD = CandidateSet.empty() 14049 ? (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 14050 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0 14051 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange()) 14052 : (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript) 14053 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 14054 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()); 14055 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PD), *this, 14056 OCD_AllCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc); 14057 return ExprError(); 14058 } 14059 14060 case OR_Ambiguous: 14061 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14062 PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 14063 << "[]" << Args[0]->getType() 14064 << Args[1]->getType() 14065 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 14066 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()), 14067 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc); 14068 return ExprError(); 14069 14070 case OR_Deleted: 14071 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14072 PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 14073 << "[]" << Args[0]->getSourceRange() 14074 << Args[1]->getSourceRange()), 14075 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc); 14076 return ExprError(); 14077 } 14078 14079 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 14080 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc); 14081 } 14082 14083 /// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member 14084 /// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member 14085 /// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the 14086 /// arguments to the function call (not including the object 14087 /// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member 14088 /// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded 14089 /// member function. 14090 ExprResult 14091 Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE, 14092 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 14093 MultiExprArg Args, 14094 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 14095 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy || 14096 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 14097 14098 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object 14099 // argument and the member function we're referring to. 14100 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens(); 14101 14102 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function. 14103 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) { 14104 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy); 14105 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI); 14106 14107 QualType fnType = 14108 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 14109 14110 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 14111 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context); 14112 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getReturnType()); 14113 14114 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the 14115 // member function we're calling. 14116 Qualifiers funcQuals = proto->getMethodQuals(); 14117 14118 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType(); 14119 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) 14120 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 14121 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers(); 14122 14123 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals; 14124 difference.removeObjCGCAttr(); 14125 difference.removeAddressSpace(); 14126 if (difference) { 14127 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString(); 14128 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals) 14129 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType() 14130 << qualsString 14131 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2); 14132 } 14133 14134 CXXMemberCallExpr *call = CXXMemberCallExpr::Create( 14135 Context, MemExprE, Args, resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc, 14136 CurFPFeatureOverrides(), proto->getNumParams()); 14137 14138 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getReturnType(), op->getRHS()->getBeginLoc(), 14139 call, nullptr)) 14140 return ExprError(); 14141 14142 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, nullptr, proto, Args, RParenLoc)) 14143 return ExprError(); 14144 14145 if (CheckOtherCall(call, proto)) 14146 return ExprError(); 14147 14148 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call); 14149 } 14150 14151 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) 14152 return CallExpr::Create(Context, MemExprE, Args, Context.VoidTy, VK_RValue, 14153 RParenLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14154 14155 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 14156 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) 14157 return ExprError(); 14158 14159 MemberExpr *MemExpr; 14160 CXXMethodDecl *Method = nullptr; 14161 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_public); 14162 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = nullptr; 14163 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) { 14164 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 14165 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl()); 14166 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl(); 14167 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier(); 14168 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 14169 } else { 14170 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 14171 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier(); 14172 14173 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType(); 14174 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification 14175 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue() 14176 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context); 14177 14178 // Add overload candidates 14179 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 14180 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 14181 14182 // FIXME: avoid copy. 14183 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 14184 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 14185 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 14186 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 14187 } 14188 14189 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(), 14190 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 14191 14192 NamedDecl *Func = *I; 14193 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()); 14194 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)) 14195 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl(); 14196 14197 14198 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls. 14199 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) { 14200 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), Args, 14201 CandidateSet, 14202 /*SuppressUserConversions*/ false); 14203 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) { 14204 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a 14205 // non-template member function. 14206 if (TemplateArgs) 14207 continue; 14208 14209 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType, 14210 ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 14211 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 14212 } else { 14213 AddMethodTemplateCandidate( 14214 cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), ActingDC, 14215 TemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 14216 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 14217 } 14218 } 14219 14220 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName(); 14221 14222 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 14223 14224 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14225 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getBeginLoc(), 14226 Best)) { 14227 case OR_Success: 14228 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 14229 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl; 14230 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl); 14231 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc())) 14232 return ExprError(); 14233 // If FoundDecl is different from Method (such as if one is a template 14234 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is 14235 // called on both. 14236 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying 14237 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl 14238 // being used. 14239 if (Method != FoundDecl.getDecl() && 14240 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Method, UnresExpr->getNameLoc())) 14241 return ExprError(); 14242 break; 14243 14244 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 14245 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14246 PartialDiagnosticAt( 14247 UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 14248 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call) 14249 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()), 14250 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14251 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 14252 return ExprError(); 14253 14254 case OR_Ambiguous: 14255 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14256 PartialDiagnosticAt(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 14257 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call) 14258 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()), 14259 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args); 14260 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 14261 return ExprError(); 14262 14263 case OR_Deleted: 14264 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14265 PartialDiagnosticAt(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 14266 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call) 14267 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()), 14268 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14269 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 14270 return ExprError(); 14271 } 14272 14273 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method); 14274 14275 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a 14276 // non-member call based on that function. 14277 if (Method->isStatic()) { 14278 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, Args, 14279 RParenLoc); 14280 } 14281 14282 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens()); 14283 } 14284 14285 QualType ResultType = Method->getReturnType(); 14286 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType); 14287 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14288 14289 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?"); 14290 const auto *Proto = Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 14291 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall = CXXMemberCallExpr::Create( 14292 Context, MemExprE, Args, ResultType, VK, RParenLoc, 14293 CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Proto->getNumParams()); 14294 14295 // Check for a valid return type. 14296 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(), 14297 TheCall, Method)) 14298 return ExprError(); 14299 14300 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call). 14301 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise 14302 // it was done at lookup. 14303 if (!Method->isStatic()) { 14304 ExprResult ObjectArg = 14305 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier, 14306 FoundDecl, Method); 14307 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid()) 14308 return ExprError(); 14309 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.get()); 14310 } 14311 14312 // Convert the rest of the arguments 14313 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, 14314 RParenLoc)) 14315 return ExprError(); 14316 14317 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args); 14318 14319 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto)) 14320 return ExprError(); 14321 14322 // In the case the method to call was not selected by the overloading 14323 // resolution process, we still need to handle the enable_if attribute. Do 14324 // that here, so it will not hide previous -- and more relevant -- errors. 14325 if (auto *MemE = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) { 14326 if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr = 14327 CheckEnableIf(Method, LParenLoc, Args, true)) { 14328 Diag(MemE->getMemberLoc(), 14329 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call) 14330 << Method << Method->getSourceRange(); 14331 Diag(Method->getLocation(), 14332 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr) 14333 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 14334 return ExprError(); 14335 } 14336 } 14337 14338 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) || 14339 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) && 14340 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) { 14341 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl(); 14342 14343 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts()) && 14344 MemExpr->performsVirtualDispatch(getLangOpts())) { 14345 Diag(MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), 14346 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor) 14347 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext) 14348 << MD->getParent(); 14349 14350 Diag(MD->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName(); 14351 if (getLangOpts().AppleKext) 14352 Diag(MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_pure_qualified_call_kext) 14353 << MD->getParent() << MD->getDeclName(); 14354 } 14355 } 14356 14357 if (CXXDestructorDecl *DD = 14358 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(TheCall->getMethodDecl())) { 14359 // a->A::f() doesn't go through the vtable, except in AppleKext mode. 14360 bool CallCanBeVirtual = !MemExpr->hasQualifier() || getLangOpts().AppleKext; 14361 CheckVirtualDtorCall(DD, MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), /*IsDelete=*/false, 14362 CallCanBeVirtual, /*WarnOnNonAbstractTypes=*/true, 14363 MemExpr->getMemberLoc()); 14364 } 14365 14366 return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall), 14367 TheCall->getMethodDecl()); 14368 } 14369 14370 /// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class 14371 /// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an 14372 /// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a 14373 /// user-defined conversion on the object argument. 14374 ExprResult 14375 Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj, 14376 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 14377 MultiExprArg Args, 14378 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 14379 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj)) 14380 return ExprError(); 14381 ExprResult Object = Obj; 14382 14383 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 14384 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) 14385 return ExprError(); 14386 14387 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && 14388 "Requires object type argument"); 14389 14390 // C++ [over.call.object]p1: 14391 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax 14392 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of 14393 // candidate functions includes at least the function call 14394 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by 14395 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of 14396 // (E).operator(). 14397 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc, 14398 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 14399 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call); 14400 14401 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(), 14402 diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get())) 14403 return true; 14404 14405 const auto *Record = Object.get()->getType()->castAs<RecordType>(); 14406 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 14407 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl()); 14408 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 14409 14410 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 14411 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 14412 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(), 14413 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, CandidateSet, 14414 /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false); 14415 } 14416 14417 // C++ [over.call.object]p2: 14418 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function 14419 // declared in T of the form 14420 // 14421 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier; 14422 // 14423 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a 14424 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id 14425 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning 14426 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of 14427 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function 14428 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...] 14429 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly, 14430 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate 14431 // functions for each conversion function declared in an 14432 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden 14433 // within T by another intervening declaration. 14434 const auto &Conversions = 14435 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 14436 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 14437 NamedDecl *D = *I; 14438 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 14439 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 14440 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 14441 14442 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't 14443 // surrogates. 14444 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 14445 continue; 14446 14447 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 14448 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) { 14449 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if 14450 // any) to get down to what might be a function type. 14451 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 14452 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 14453 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 14454 14455 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 14456 { 14457 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto, 14458 Object.get(), Args, CandidateSet); 14459 } 14460 } 14461 } 14462 14463 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 14464 14465 // Perform overload resolution. 14466 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14467 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), 14468 Best)) { 14469 case OR_Success: 14470 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call 14471 // below. 14472 break; 14473 14474 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 14475 PartialDiagnostic PD = 14476 CandidateSet.empty() 14477 ? (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 14478 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1 14479 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()) 14480 : (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call) 14481 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange()); 14482 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14483 PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), PD), *this, 14484 OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14485 break; 14486 } 14487 case OR_Ambiguous: 14488 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14489 PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), 14490 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call) 14491 << Object.get()->getType() 14492 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()), 14493 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args); 14494 break; 14495 14496 case OR_Deleted: 14497 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14498 PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), 14499 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call) 14500 << Object.get()->getType() 14501 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()), 14502 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14503 break; 14504 } 14505 14506 if (Best == CandidateSet.end()) 14507 return true; 14508 14509 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 14510 14511 if (Best->Function == nullptr) { 14512 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the 14513 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function. 14514 CXXConversionDecl *Conv 14515 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>( 14516 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction); 14517 14518 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, 14519 Best->FoundDecl); 14520 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc)) 14521 return ExprError(); 14522 assert(Conv == Best->FoundDecl.getDecl() && 14523 "Found Decl & conversion-to-functionptr should be same, right?!"); 14524 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the 14525 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion 14526 // on the object argument, then let BuildCallExpr finish the job. 14527 14528 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator. 14529 // and then call it. 14530 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl, 14531 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates); 14532 if (Call.isInvalid()) 14533 return ExprError(); 14534 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 14535 Call = ImplicitCastExpr::Create( 14536 Context, Call.get()->getType(), CK_UserDefinedConversion, Call.get(), 14537 nullptr, VK_RValue, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14538 14539 return BuildCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc); 14540 } 14541 14542 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 14543 14544 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr 14545 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object 14546 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments. 14547 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 14548 14549 // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration. 14550 if (Method->isInvalidDecl()) 14551 return ExprError(); 14552 14553 const auto *Proto = Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 14554 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 14555 14556 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo( 14557 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc); 14558 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc)); 14559 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl, 14560 Obj, HadMultipleCandidates, 14561 OpLocInfo.getLoc(), 14562 OpLocInfo.getInfo()); 14563 if (NewFn.isInvalid()) 14564 return true; 14565 14566 // The number of argument slots to allocate in the call. If we have default 14567 // arguments we need to allocate space for them as well. We additionally 14568 // need one more slot for the object parameter. 14569 unsigned NumArgsSlots = 1 + std::max<unsigned>(Args.size(), NumParams); 14570 14571 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the implicit object 14572 // parameter is placed at the beginning of the list). 14573 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> MethodArgs(NumArgsSlots); 14574 14575 bool IsError = false; 14576 14577 // Initialize the implicit object parameter. 14578 ExprResult ObjRes = 14579 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 14580 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 14581 if (ObjRes.isInvalid()) 14582 IsError = true; 14583 else 14584 Object = ObjRes; 14585 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get(); 14586 14587 // Check the argument types. 14588 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumParams; i++) { 14589 Expr *Arg; 14590 if (i < Args.size()) { 14591 Arg = Args[i]; 14592 14593 // Pass the argument. 14594 14595 ExprResult InputInit 14596 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 14597 Context, 14598 Method->getParamDecl(i)), 14599 SourceLocation(), Arg); 14600 14601 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid(); 14602 Arg = InputInit.getAs<Expr>(); 14603 } else { 14604 ExprResult DefArg 14605 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i)); 14606 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) { 14607 IsError = true; 14608 break; 14609 } 14610 14611 Arg = DefArg.getAs<Expr>(); 14612 } 14613 14614 MethodArgs[i + 1] = Arg; 14615 } 14616 14617 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...". 14618 if (Proto->isVariadic()) { 14619 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7). 14620 for (unsigned i = NumParams, e = Args.size(); i < e; i++) { 14621 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 14622 nullptr); 14623 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid(); 14624 MethodArgs[i + 1] = Arg.get(); 14625 } 14626 } 14627 14628 if (IsError) 14629 return true; 14630 14631 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args); 14632 14633 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly owned. 14634 QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType(); 14635 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 14636 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14637 14638 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create( 14639 Context, OO_Call, NewFn.get(), MethodArgs, ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc, 14640 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14641 14642 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), LParenLoc, TheCall, Method)) 14643 return true; 14644 14645 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto)) 14646 return true; 14647 14648 return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall), Method); 14649 } 14650 14651 /// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator-> 14652 /// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and 14653 /// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find. 14654 ExprResult 14655 Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc, 14656 bool *NoArrowOperatorFound) { 14657 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() && 14658 "left-hand side must have class type"); 14659 14660 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base)) 14661 return ExprError(); 14662 14663 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc(); 14664 14665 // C++ [over.ref]p1: 14666 // 14667 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m 14668 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if 14669 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the 14670 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3). 14671 DeclarationName OpName = 14672 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow); 14673 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 14674 14675 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(), 14676 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base)) 14677 return ExprError(); 14678 14679 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 14680 LookupQualifiedName(R, Base->getType()->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 14681 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 14682 14683 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 14684 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 14685 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context), 14686 None, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false); 14687 } 14688 14689 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 14690 14691 // Perform overload resolution. 14692 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14693 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 14694 case OR_Success: 14695 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below. 14696 break; 14697 14698 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 14699 auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base); 14700 if (CandidateSet.empty()) { 14701 QualType BaseType = Base->getType(); 14702 if (NoArrowOperatorFound) { 14703 // Report this specific error to the caller instead of emitting a 14704 // diagnostic, as requested. 14705 *NoArrowOperatorFound = true; 14706 return ExprError(); 14707 } 14708 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow) 14709 << BaseType << Base->getSourceRange(); 14710 if (BaseType->isRecordType() && !BaseType->isPointerType()) { 14711 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion) 14712 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "."); 14713 } 14714 } else 14715 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 14716 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange(); 14717 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, Base, Cands); 14718 return ExprError(); 14719 } 14720 case OR_Ambiguous: 14721 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14722 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 14723 << "->" << Base->getType() 14724 << Base->getSourceRange()), 14725 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Base); 14726 return ExprError(); 14727 14728 case OR_Deleted: 14729 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14730 PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 14731 << "->" << Base->getSourceRange()), 14732 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base); 14733 return ExprError(); 14734 } 14735 14736 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 14737 14738 // Convert the object parameter. 14739 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 14740 ExprResult BaseResult = 14741 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 14742 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 14743 if (BaseResult.isInvalid()) 14744 return ExprError(); 14745 Base = BaseResult.get(); 14746 14747 // Build the operator call. 14748 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl, 14749 Base, HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 14750 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 14751 return ExprError(); 14752 14753 QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType(); 14754 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 14755 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14756 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 14757 CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.get(), Base, 14758 ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14759 14760 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, Method)) 14761 return ExprError(); 14762 14763 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, 14764 Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>())) 14765 return ExprError(); 14766 14767 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 14768 } 14769 14770 /// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to 14771 /// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results. 14772 ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R, 14773 DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo, 14774 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args, 14775 SourceLocation LitEndLoc, 14776 TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 14777 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(); 14778 14779 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc, 14780 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 14781 AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, 14782 TemplateArgs); 14783 14784 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 14785 14786 // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need 14787 // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template. 14788 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14789 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) { 14790 case OR_Success: 14791 case OR_Deleted: 14792 break; 14793 14794 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 14795 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14796 PartialDiagnosticAt(UDSuffixLoc, 14797 PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 14798 << R.getLookupName()), 14799 *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 14800 return ExprError(); 14801 14802 case OR_Ambiguous: 14803 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates( 14804 PartialDiagnosticAt(R.getNameLoc(), PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) 14805 << R.getLookupName()), 14806 *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args); 14807 return ExprError(); 14808 } 14809 14810 FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function; 14811 ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl, 14812 nullptr, HadMultipleCandidates, 14813 SuffixInfo.getLoc(), 14814 SuffixInfo.getInfo()); 14815 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 14816 return true; 14817 14818 // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except 14819 // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals. 14820 Expr *ConvArgs[2]; 14821 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 14822 ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization( 14823 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)), 14824 SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]); 14825 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 14826 return true; 14827 ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.get(); 14828 } 14829 14830 QualType ResultTy = FD->getReturnType(); 14831 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 14832 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14833 14834 UserDefinedLiteral *UDL = UserDefinedLiteral::Create( 14835 Context, Fn.get(), llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()), ResultTy, 14836 VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14837 14838 if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getReturnType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD)) 14839 return ExprError(); 14840 14841 if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, nullptr)) 14842 return ExprError(); 14843 14844 return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL), FD); 14845 } 14846 14847 /// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the 14848 /// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which 14849 /// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument 14850 /// dependent lookup. 14851 /// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success, 14852 /// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value 14853 /// is returned. 14854 Sema::ForRangeStatus 14855 Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(SourceLocation Loc, 14856 SourceLocation RangeLoc, 14857 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 14858 LookupResult &MemberLookup, 14859 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 14860 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) { 14861 Scope *S = nullptr; 14862 14863 CandidateSet->clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 14864 if (!MemberLookup.empty()) { 14865 ExprResult MemberRef = 14866 BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc, 14867 /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(), 14868 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 14869 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr, 14870 MemberLookup, 14871 /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr, S); 14872 if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) { 14873 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14874 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 14875 } 14876 *CallExpr = BuildCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, None, Loc, nullptr); 14877 if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) { 14878 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14879 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 14880 } 14881 } else { 14882 ExprResult FnR = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(/*NamingClass=*/nullptr, 14883 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), 14884 NameInfo, UnresolvedSet<0>()); 14885 if (FnR.isInvalid()) 14886 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 14887 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(FnR.get()); 14888 14889 bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, Range, Loc, 14890 CandidateSet, CallExpr); 14891 if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) { 14892 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14893 return FRS_NoViableFunction; 14894 } 14895 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 14896 OverloadingResult OverloadResult = 14897 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best); 14898 14899 if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) { 14900 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14901 return FRS_NoViableFunction; 14902 } 14903 *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, Range, 14904 Loc, nullptr, CandidateSet, &Best, 14905 OverloadResult, 14906 /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false); 14907 if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) { 14908 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 14909 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 14910 } 14911 } 14912 return FRS_Success; 14913 } 14914 14915 14916 /// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to 14917 /// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and 14918 /// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function 14919 /// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to 14920 /// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr. 14921 Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found, 14922 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 14923 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) { 14924 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(), 14925 Found, Fn); 14926 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr()) 14927 return PE; 14928 14929 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr); 14930 } 14931 14932 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) { 14933 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(), 14934 Found, Fn); 14935 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(), 14936 SubExpr->getType()) && 14937 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload"); 14938 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?"); 14939 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr()) 14940 return ICE; 14941 14942 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(), ICE->getCastKind(), 14943 SubExpr, nullptr, ICE->getValueKind(), 14944 CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 14945 } 14946 14947 if (auto *GSE = dyn_cast<GenericSelectionExpr>(E)) { 14948 if (!GSE->isResultDependent()) { 14949 Expr *SubExpr = 14950 FixOverloadedFunctionReference(GSE->getResultExpr(), Found, Fn); 14951 if (SubExpr == GSE->getResultExpr()) 14952 return GSE; 14953 14954 // Replace the resulting type information before rebuilding the generic 14955 // selection expression. 14956 ArrayRef<Expr *> A = GSE->getAssocExprs(); 14957 SmallVector<Expr *, 4> AssocExprs(A.begin(), A.end()); 14958 unsigned ResultIdx = GSE->getResultIndex(); 14959 AssocExprs[ResultIdx] = SubExpr; 14960 14961 return GenericSelectionExpr::Create( 14962 Context, GSE->getGenericLoc(), GSE->getControllingExpr(), 14963 GSE->getAssocTypeSourceInfos(), AssocExprs, GSE->getDefaultLoc(), 14964 GSE->getRParenLoc(), GSE->containsUnexpandedParameterPack(), 14965 ResultIdx); 14966 } 14967 // Rather than fall through to the unreachable, return the original generic 14968 // selection expression. 14969 return GSE; 14970 } 14971 14972 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) { 14973 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && 14974 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function"); 14975 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 14976 if (Method->isStatic()) { 14977 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different 14978 // from non-member functions. 14979 } else { 14980 // Fix the subexpression, which really has to be an 14981 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function 14982 // or template. 14983 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 14984 Found, Fn); 14985 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 14986 return UnOp; 14987 14988 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr) 14989 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref"); 14990 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier() 14991 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier"); 14992 14993 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member 14994 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the 14995 // appropriate pointer to member type. 14996 QualType ClassType 14997 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext())); 14998 QualType MemPtrType 14999 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr()); 15000 // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now. 15001 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 15002 (void)isCompleteType(UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), MemPtrType); 15003 15004 return UnaryOperator::Create( 15005 Context, SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 15006 UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), false, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 15007 } 15008 } 15009 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 15010 Found, Fn); 15011 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 15012 return UnOp; 15013 15014 return UnaryOperator::Create(Context, SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, 15015 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()), 15016 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), 15017 false, CurFPFeatureOverrides()); 15018 } 15019 15020 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) { 15021 // FIXME: avoid copy. 15022 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 15023 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 15024 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 15025 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 15026 } 15027 15028 DeclRefExpr *DRE = 15029 BuildDeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, ULE->getNameInfo(), 15030 ULE->getQualifierLoc(), Found.getDecl(), 15031 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), TemplateArgs); 15032 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1); 15033 return DRE; 15034 } 15035 15036 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) { 15037 // FIXME: avoid copy. 15038 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 15039 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 15040 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 15041 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 15042 } 15043 15044 Expr *Base; 15045 15046 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an 15047 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref. 15048 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) { 15049 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) { 15050 DeclRefExpr *DRE = BuildDeclRefExpr( 15051 Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, MemExpr->getNameInfo(), 15052 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), Found.getDecl(), 15053 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), TemplateArgs); 15054 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); 15055 return DRE; 15056 } else { 15057 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc(); 15058 if (MemExpr->getQualifier()) 15059 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc(); 15060 Base = 15061 BuildCXXThisExpr(Loc, MemExpr->getBaseType(), /*IsImplicit=*/true); 15062 } 15063 } else 15064 Base = MemExpr->getBase(); 15065 15066 ExprValueKind valueKind; 15067 QualType type; 15068 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) { 15069 valueKind = VK_LValue; 15070 type = Fn->getType(); 15071 } else { 15072 valueKind = VK_RValue; 15073 type = Context.BoundMemberTy; 15074 } 15075 15076 return BuildMemberExpr( 15077 Base, MemExpr->isArrow(), MemExpr->getOperatorLoc(), 15078 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), Fn, Found, 15079 /*HadMultipleCandidates=*/true, MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(), 15080 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary, TemplateArgs); 15081 } 15082 15083 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function"); 15084 } 15085 15086 ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E, 15087 DeclAccessPair Found, 15088 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 15089 return FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E.get(), Found, Fn); 15090 } 15091